Professional Documents
Culture Documents
Owner's Manual
Owner's Manual
(U NBA
dBV
–10
L
OFF
ON 15
+ 48V
OM 13 R
ANT
NES
T
PH OU
16 IN PHO
2TR
14
OR
NIT
MOR IN
2T
6 10
15/1R IN
2T EL
LEV
0
10
EL NES
LEV PHO
0
B OR
26d –20 NIT
+10 GAIN
MO UT
B O
26d –20
6
15/1
10 I N
+ GA
B
26d –60
4
13/1
–34
–16 GAIN
B +10
26d –60
–34
–16 GAIN 12
Owner’s10Manual
26d
B +10
–60
11 –16 GAIN
+10
–34
L E R EO
R
–60
–34 O NSO L STE
–16 GAIN IN GC CLI
P
–60
+10 MIX –3
AL
–16 GAIN
–34
9 IGIT H –6
+10
D HIG –9
–60
–34
EQ –12
GA
IN 8 –15
PAN ID –18
7 HI-M –24
–30
–36
–42
F MID
LO- –48
PAN
F LOW
G G
NEL
C HAN
EC TED
SEL
2
ET URN
1R SEL
REO SEL
STE
2
U RN ER
RET AST
5/16
1 M
1 SEL SO
4
13/1 SEL SOL
O
12 SEL
interstage
Phistersvej 31, 2900 Hellerup, Danmark
Telefon 3946 0000, fax 3946 0040
11 SEL O E
www.interstage.dk
10 SOL ON
SEL
- pro audio with a smile
O
9 SOL
EL ON
FCC INFORMATION (U.S.A.)
1. IMPORTANT NOTICE: DO NOT MODIFY THIS UNIT!
This product, when installed as indicated in the instructions contained in this manual, meets FCC requirements. Modifications not expressly approved by Yamaha
may void your authority, granted by the FCC, to use the product.
2. IMPORTANT: When connecting this product to accessories and/or another product use only high quality shielded cables. Cable/s supplied with this product MUST
be used. Follow all installation instructions. Failure to follow instructions could void your FCC authorization to use this product in the USA.
3. NOTE: This product has been tested and found to comply with the requirements listed in FCC Regulations, Part 15 for Class “B” digital devices. Compliance with
these requirements provides a reasonable level of assurance that your use of this product in a residential environment will not result in harmful interference with
other electronic devices. This equipment generates/uses radio frequencies and, if not installed and used according to the instructions found in the users manual, may
cause interference harmful to the operation of other electronic devices. Compliance with FCC regulations does not guarantee that interference will not occur in all
installations. If this product is found to be the source of interference, which can be determined by turning the unit “OFF” and “ON”, please try to eliminate the
problem by using one of the following measures:
Relocate either this product or the device that is being affected by the interference.
Utilize power outlets that are on different branch (circuit breaker or fuse) circuits or install AC line filter/s.
In the case of radio or TV interference, relocate/reorient the antenna. If the antenna lead-in is 300 ohm ribbon lead, change the lead-in to coaxial type cable.
If these corrective measures do not produce satisfactory results, please contact the local retailer authorized to distribute this type of product. If you can not locate the
appropriate retailer, please contact Yamaha Corporation of America, Electronic Service Division, 6600 Orangethorpe Ave, Buena Park, CA 90620
● Dit apparaat bevat een lithium batterij voor geheugen ● This apparatus contains a lithium battery for memory
back-up. back-up.
● Raadpleeg uw leverancier over de verwijdering van de ● For the removal of the battery at the moment of the
batterij op het moment dat u het apparaat ann het einde disposal at the end of the service life please consult your
van de levensduur afdankt of de volgende Yamaha Service retailer or Yamaha Service Center as follows:
Afdeiing: Yamaha Music Nederland Service Center
Yamaha Music Nederland Service Afdeiing Address: Kanaalweg 18-G, 3526 KL
Kanaalweg 18-G, 3526 KL UTRECHT UTRECHT
Tel. 030-2828425 Tel: 030-2828425
● Gooi de batterij niet weg, maar lever hem in als KCA. ● Do not throw away the battery. Instead, hand it in as small
chemical waste.
i
Important Information
Read the Following Before Operating the 01V
Warnings
• Do not locate the 01V in a place subject to excessive heat or in direct sunlight. This
could be a fire hazard.
• Do not place the 01V in a place subject to excessive humidity or dust. This could be
a fire and electrical shock hazard.
• Connect the 01V power cord only to an AC outlet of the type stated in this Owner’s
Manual or as marked on the 01V. Failure to do so is a fire and electrical shock hazard.
• Do not plug several devices into the same AC outlet. This can overload the AC outlet,
and can be a fire and electrical shock hazard. It may also affect the performance of
some devices.
• Do not place heavy objects on the power cord. A damaged power cord is a potential
fire and electrical shock hazard.
• If the power cord is damaged (i.e., cut or a bare wire is exposed), ask your dealer for
a replacement. Using the 01V in this condition is a fire and shock hazard.
• Hold the power cord plug when disconnecting from an AC outlet. Never pull the
cord. Damaging the power cord in this way is a potential fire and electrical shock
hazard.
• Do not place small metal objects on top of the 01V. Metal objects inside the 01V are
a fire and electrical shock hazard.
• Do not block the 01V ventilation slots. The 01V has ventilation slots on the top and
rear to prevent the internal temperature from rising. Blocked ventilation slots are a
fire hazard.
• Do not try to modify the 01V. This could be a fire and electrical shock hazard.
• The 01V operating temperature is between 5˚C and 35˚C (41˚F and 95˚F).
Cautions
• Turn off all audio devices and speakers when connecting to the 01V. Refer to the
owner’s manual for each device. Use the correct cables and connect as specified.
• If you notice any abnormality—such as smoke, odor, or noise—turn off the 01V
immediately. Remove the power cord from the AC outlet. Confirm that the abnor-
mality is no longer present. Consult your dealer for repair. Using the 01V in this con-
dition is a fire and shock hazard.
• If a foreign object or water gets inside the 01V, turn it off immediately. Remove the
power cord from the AC outlet. Consult your dealer for repair. Using the 01V in this
condition is a fire and electrical shock hazard.
• If you plan not to use the 01V for a long period of time, remove the power cord from
the AC outlet. Leaving the 01V connected is a fire hazard.
• Do not use benzene, thinner, cleaning detergent, or a chemical cloth to clean the 01V.
Use only a soft, dry cloth.
• The 01V is a heavy piece of equipment. Always grip the underneath, not the side pan-
els, when lifting.
01V—Owner’s Manual
ii
Interference
01V uses high-frequency digital circuits that may cause interference on radios and tele-
visions placed close to it. If interference does occur, relocate the affected equipment.
Copyright
© 1998 Yamaha Corporation. All rights reserved.
No part of the 01V software or this Owner’s Manual may be reproduced or distributed
in any form or by any means without the prior written authorization of Yamaha Cor-
poration.
Trademarks
ADAT MultiChannel Optical Digital Interface is a trademark and ADAT and Alesis are
registered trademarks of Alesis Corporation. Macintosh is a registered trademark of
Apple Computer, Inc. Pro Tools is a registered trademark of Digidesign or Avid Tech-
nology, Inc. Tascam Digital Interface is a trademark and Tascam and TEAC are regis-
tered trademarks of TEAC Corporation. Windows is a trademark of Microsoft
Corporation.
All other trademarks are the property of their respective holders and are hereby
acknowledged.
Package Contents
The 01V package should contain the following items. Make sure that you have them all.
• 01V Digital Mixing Console
• Owner’s Manual
Contact your Yamaha dealer if anything is missing.
01V—Owner’s Manual
Contents iii
Contents
1 Welcome to the 01V . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1
Welcome to the 01V . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2
About this Owner’s Manual . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2
01V Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2
01V Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3
Key Feature Discussion . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4
2 Getting Started . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9
01V System Example . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10
Important Wordclock Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11
Connecting the Power Cord . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11
Turning On the 01V . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11
Turning Off the 01V . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11
5 Input Channels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39
Input Channel Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40
Phantom Powering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41
Pad Switches . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41
Setting Input Channel Gain . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41
Metering Input Channels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41
Changing the Input Phase . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42
Attenuating Input Channel Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43
Applying EQ to Input Channels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44
Input Channels Dynamics Processors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44
Delaying Channel Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45
Muting Input Channels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46
Setting Input Channel Levels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46
Panning Input Channels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47
Routing Input Channels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49
Monitoring Input Channels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50
Input Channels & Aux Sends . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50
01V—Owner’s Manual
iv Contents
6 EQ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61
About the 01V EQ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62
Adjusting the EQ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 63
EQ Specs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 66
Bypassing the EQ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 66
Resetting the EQ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 66
EQ Library . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67
Preset EQ Program List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67
Storing EQ Programs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68
Recalling EQ Programs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69
Editing EQ Program Titles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70
Preset EQ Program Parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71
8 Stereo Output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 87
About the Stereo Output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88
Analog Stereo Output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88
2TR Out & the Stereo Output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88
Coaxial Digital Out & the Stereo Output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88
Option I/O & the Stereo Output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88
Omni Outs & the Stereo Output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88
Solo & the Stereo Output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88
Monitoring the Stereo Output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88
01V—Owner’s Manual
Contents v
9 Aux Sends . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 93
About the Aux Sends . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 94
Option I/O & the Aux Sends . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 94
Omni Outs & the Aux Sends . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 94
Monitoring Aux Sends . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 94
Metering Aux Sends . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 94
Sending Channel Signals to Aux Sends . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95
Pre-fader/Post-fader Aux Sends . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 97
Viewing Aux Send Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98
Setting Aux Send Master Levels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99
Muting Aux Sends . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100
Applying EQ to Aux Sends . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100
Aux Send Dynamics Processors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100
Pairing Aux Sends . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101
Aux Send Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 104
Stereo Pair Aux Send Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 105
01V—Owner’s Manual
vi Contents
12 Effects . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119
About the Onboard Effects . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120
Preset Effects Programs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 121
Using the Effects . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123
Pre-fader/Post-fader Effects Sends . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125
Viewing Effects Send Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 127
Metering Effects Sends . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 127
Setting Effects Send Master Levels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 128
Muting Effects Sends . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 129
Viewing Effects Returns Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 130
Metering Effects Returns . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 130
Applying EQ to Effects Returns . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 130
Muting Effects Returns . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 130
Setting Effects Returns Levels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 131
Panning Effects Returns . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 131
Routing Effects Returns . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 131
Monitoring Effects Returns . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 131
Effects Returns & Aux Sends . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 131
Effects Library . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 132
Storing Effects Programs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 133
Recalling Effects Programs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 134
Editing Effects Program Titles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135
Editing Effects . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 136
Setting Delay, Freq, Note & Tempo Parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 137
Effects Parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 138
Effects Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 159
01V—Owner’s Manual
Contents vii
17 MIDI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 221
MIDI & the 01V . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 222
MIDI Ports . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 222
MIDI Receive Indicators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 224
MIDI Setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 224
Program Change Scene Recall . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 227
Control Change Parameter Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 229
System Exclusive Parameter Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 231
Bulk Dump . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 232
Local Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 234
MIDI Machine Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 236
User Defined MIDI Controllers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 238
Linking 01Vs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 239
Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 253
01V—Owner’s Manual
viii Contents
Glossary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 293
Index . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 297
01V—Owner’s Manual
Welcome to the 01V 1
1
In this chapter...
01V—Owner’s Manual
2 Chapter 1—Welcome to the 01V
01V Installation
Site the 01V on a stable surface, somewhere that complies with the important informa-
tion at the front of this manual. The 01V can be rack-mounted using an optional
rack-mount kit.
01V—Owner’s Manual
01V Features 3
01V Features
01V Sonic Specs
• Linear 20-bit 128-times oversampling A/D converters
• Linear 20-bit 8-times oversampling D/A converters (STEREO OUT)
• 105 dB typical dynamic range (CH INPUT to STEREO OUT)
• 20 Hz–20 kHz (+1, –3 dB) frequency response
• 32-bit internal digital audio processing
• 44-bit digital EQ processing
01V Features
• 24 inputs (including 8 digital inputs)
• 14 outputs (STEREO OUT, OMNI OUTs, 8 assignable digital outputs)
• Continuously variable gain controls
• Balanced XLRs with +48 V phantom powering (input channels 1 through 12)
• 26 dB pad (input channels 1 through 12)
• Balanced phone jack inputs (input channels 1 through 16)
• Four configurable analog Omni outs (AUX, BUS, CH DIRECT, STEREO)
• Option I/O slot for digital interface with 8-track digital multitrack recorders
• 8 assignable digital outputs from an Option I/O card (Tascam, ADAT, AES/EBU)
• Coaxial-type digital input and output
• Versatile solo modes for comprehensive monitoring
• 3 fader groups for multiple fader control
• 3 mute groups for multiple mute control
• 250 ms input delay (1–16) and 300 ms output delay (STEREO OUT, OMNI OUTs)
• Channel Copy function
• Stereo-pair operation for input channels, aux sends, and bus outs
• 100 scene memories for storing mix snapshots
• Four-band parametric EQ (2-band on Option I/O input channels)
• Powerful EQ library with 40 preset programs and 40 user programs
• Dedicated controls for EQ and pan
• Two stereo multi-effects processors onboard
• Powerful effects library with 42 preset programs and 57 user programs
• The equivalent of 22 dynamics processors onboard (compressor, gate, ducking,
expander, compander)
• Powerful dynamics library with 40 preset programs and 40 user programs
• 320 x 80 dot LCD display
• Comprehensive MIDI implementation (remote control, MMC, Bulk)
• Built-in MIDI interface and TO HOST port for quick and simple connection to a
personal computer
• 15 motorized 60 mm faders
01V—Owner’s Manual
4 Chapter 1—Welcome to the 01V
01V—Owner’s Manual
Key Feature Discussion 5
Motorized Faders
The 01V features 15 motorized 60 mm faders that move automatically when a mix
scene is recalled, providing a clear and visual indication of fader levels. A fade time of
up to 25 seconds can be set for each mix scene individually. Faders can be grouped
together in one of three fader groups for multiple fader control. See “Grouping Faders”
on page 55 for more information. Faders on paired channels move simultaneously. See
“Pairing Input Channels” on page 52 for more information.
01V Faders are multifunction controls, and their exact operation depends on the
selected Fader mode. Input channel faders may be used as channel faders or aux or
effects send controls. The STEREO fader may be used as the stereo output fader or aux
or effects send master level faders. See “Fader Modes” on page 32 for more information.
Faders 1 through 16 and master can be assigned to various internal parameters on
REMOTE page 1, or used as MIDI controllers on REMOTE page 3. See “Assigning Fad-
ers & On Buttons” on page 194 and “User Defined MIDI Controllers” on page 238 for
more information.
01V—Owner’s Manual
6 Chapter 1—Welcome to the 01V
01V—Owner’s Manual
Key Feature Discussion 7
Scene Memories
On many mixers, the only way to store mix settings is with marker pen and masking
tape. With the 01V, however, virtually every mix setting can be stored in a mix scene
using the 01V’s 99 scene memories. Mix scenes can be recalled instantly with just one
button press, or remotely using MIDI Program Change commands. If you work on sev-
eral projects at a time, you can store the current mix scene so when you return to that
project, you can start again right where you left off. Scene memories also make light
work of night-after-night sound checks. Simply press recall to return to the previous
night’s mix settings. For theater work, scene memories allow accurate and repeatable
sound changes between scenes.
MIDI
In addition to regular MIDI ports, the 01V features a TO HOST port that allows the
01V to be connected directly to a personal computer without a MIDI interface.
MIDI Program Change messages can be used to recall mix scenes, and mix parameters
can be assigned to MIDI Control Change messages for real-time remote control. Mix
parameters that can be stored in mix scenes can be controlled remotely using MIDI Sys-
tem Exclusive messages. Scene memory, library, and setup data can be transferred to a
MIDI data filer, computer, or another 01V for backup and archive using MIDI Bulk
Dump. See “MIDI” on page 221 for more information.
When REMOTE page 2 is displayed, the 01V’s [SEL] and [ON] buttons can be used to
control recorders that support MMC (MIDI Machine Control) commands (stop, play,
rewind, forward, and record). When REMOTE page 3 is displayed, faders, [SOLO] &
[ON] buttons function as assignable MIDI Controllers.
01V—Owner’s Manual
8 Chapter 1—Welcome to the 01V
01V—Owner’s Manual
Getting Started 9
Getting Started
2
In this chapter...
01V—Owner’s Manual
10 Chapter 2—Getting Started
Monitors
Power Amp
Headphones
Personal computer
running MIDI software
PHONES
MONITOR OUT
PHANTOM +48V OFF ON
INPUT (BAL)
PHANTOM +48V OFF ON
13 15 L
–10dBV (UNBAL) Digital multitrack
14 16
R
IN
2TR
OUT
Digital in
PHONES
PAD
26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 15/16 MONITOR
2TR IN 2TR IN
–16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 +10 –20 +10 –20 0 10 0 10
+10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 GAIN GAIN LEVEL LEVEL
OPTION I/O
MONITOR
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13/14 15/16 OUT PHONES
FUNCTION
PAN
PAN
EQ HIGH
HI-MID
L STEREO R
CLIP
–3
–6
–9
8-TRACK DIGITAL
Digital out
–12
PAN/ F F –15
DYNAMICS EQ/ATT Ø/DELAY ROUTING MEMORY –18
G LO-MID –24
–30
–36
FADER MODE –42
EFFECT 1 EFFECT 2 OPTION I/O REMOTE G LOW –48
1 RETURN 2
SELECTED CHANNEL
AUX 1 AUX 2 AUX 3 AUX 4
Serial port
HOME
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON MEMORY
DAT recorder
MIDI IN OUT Digital in
DAT
–1/DEC +1/INC
PARAMETER
00.00.00.00
MIDI 6
5
6
5
6
5
6
5
6
5
6
5
6
5
6
5
6
5
6
5
6
5
6
5
6
5
6
5
0
–5
–10
–15
DIGITAL STEREO
interface
–20
COAXIAL
CURSOR
10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10
–30
20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 –40
–50
40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40
60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 –70
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
– ∞
1
17
2
18
3
19
4
20
5
21
6
22
7
23
8
24
9 10 11 12 13/14 15/16 STEREO
MASTER
IN Digital out
Drum machine
Guitar processor
MIDI IN
Tone generator
MIDI IN
Bass processor
MIDI keyboard
MIDI IN
MIDI OUT
Vocals Drums
01V—Owner’s Manual
Important Wordclock Information 11
01V—Owner’s Manual
12 Chapter 2—Getting Started
01V—Owner’s Manual
Touring the 01V 13
3
In this chapter...
01V—Owner’s Manual
14 Chapter 3—Touring the 01V
INPUT (BAL)
–10dBV (UNBAL)
13 15 L
R
14 16
IN OUT
2TR
PHONES
PAD
26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 15/16 MONITOR
2TR IN 2TR IN
–16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 +10 –20 +10 –20 0 10 0 10
+10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 GAIN GAIN LEVEL LEVEL
MONITOR
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13/14 15/16 OUT PHONES
EQ HIGH L STEREO R
PAN CLIP
UTILITY MIDI SETUP VIEW –3
–6
PAN HI-MID
FUNCTION –9
–12
PAN/ F F –15
DYNAMICS EQ/ATT Ø/DELAY ROUTING MEMORY –18
G LO-MID –24
–30
–36
FADER MODE –42
EFFECT 1 EFFECT 2 OPTION I/O REMOTE G LOW –48
1 RETURN 2
SELECTED CHANNEL
AUX 1 AUX 2 AUX 3 AUX 4
HOME
SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO
ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON MEMORY
–1/DEC +1/INC
PARAMETER
6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 0
–5
0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 –10
–15
5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5
–20
CURSOR
10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10
–30
20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 –40
–50
40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40
60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 –70
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
– ∞
ENTER
The individual sections of the 01V are explained on the following pages.
01V—Owner’s Manual
Top Panel Controls 15
1 2 3
PAD
26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 15/16 MONITOR
2TR IN 2TR IN
–16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 +10 –20 +10 –20 +10 –20 +10 –20
+10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 GAIN GAIN LEVEL LEVEL
MONITOR
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13/14 15/16 OUT PHONES
4 5 6
A PAD switches
These switches are used to turn on and off the 26 dB input pads. See “Pad Switches” on
page 41 for more information.
B 15/16–2TR IN Switch
This switch is used to select the signal source for input channels 15 and 16: phone jacks
15 and 16 (15/16) or the 2TR IN phono jacks (2TR IN).
C MONITOR–2TR IN Switch
This switch is used to select the signal source for the monitor out and phones: Monitor
bus (MONITOR) or 2TR IN phono jacks (2TR IN).
D GAIN controls
These controls are used to adjust the gain of the input preamps. See “Setting Input
Channel Gain” on page 41 for more information.
E MONITOR OUT LEVEL control
This control is used to adjust the monitor out level.
F PHONES LEVEL control
This control is used to adjust the phones level.
01V—Owner’s Manual
16 Chapter 3—Touring the 01V
EQ HIGH L STEREO R
PAN CLIP
–3
–6
PAN HI-MID
FUNCTION –9
–12
F
MEMORY 1 F
G LO-MID
–15
–18
–24 4
–30
–36
–42
G LOW –48
1 RETURN 2
SELECTED CHANNEL
2 3
A Display
This 320 x 80 dot LCD display provides clear indication of mix settings and operating
status. As well as showing parameter values numerically, faders and rotary controls are
represented graphically, so you can actually see pan and fader positions. The display
also shows EQ curves and signal level meters. See “Display” on page 28 for more infor-
mation.
B SELECTED CHANNEL Controls
These controls are used to adjust the pan and EQ of the selected channel. Dedicated
rotary controls for PAN, EQ frequency (F) and EQ gain (G), and EQ [HIGH],
[HI-MID], [LO-MID], and [LOW] buttons make for quick operation. When the EQ
AUTO SCREEN option is turned on, and an EQ control is adjusted, the EQ page
appears automatically. Likewise, for the PANPOT AUTO SCREEN option and PAN
control. See “Setting 01V Preferences” on page 203 for more information.
C Contrast
This control is used to adjust the display contrast. Adjust it so that the display is clear
and easy-to-read from your viewing position. You may need to readjust it when viewing
the display from a different height or angle.
D Stereo Output Meters
These 12-segment LED bar-type meters display the stereo output signal levels.
CURSOR
ENTER
These controls are used to navigate around the display pages and edit parameters. See
“Getting Around the User Interface” on page 27 for more information.
01V—Owner’s Manual
Top Panel Controls 17
Function Buttons
UTILITY MIDI SETUP VIEW
MEMORY
PAN/
DYNAMICS EQ/ATT Ø/DELAY ROUTING
Function buttons are used to access the following function pages. Related pages are
grouped together and can be selected by repeatedly pressing a button. The name of the
selected function and its page number appear in the top-left corner of the display.
Button Pages
UTILITY Oscillator, Preferences-1, Preferences-2
MIDI MIDI Setup, Program Change, Control Change, Bulk, Local Control
SETUP Word Clock Select, Monitor/Solo Setup, Group, Pair, Dither
VIEW Channel View, Fader View, CH Copy
DYNAMICS Dynamics Edit, Dynamics Library
EQ/ATT EQ Edit, EQ Library
ø/DELAY Phase, Input Delay 1–8, Input Delay 9–16, Output Delay
PAN/ROUTING Panpot, Routing, Bus Master, Omni Out Select
MEMORY Memory, Fade Time, Memory Sort, Recall Safe
HOME
Fader mode buttons are used to select the following fader modes and display pages.
Pressing buttons repeatedly selects the various pages that are available for a mode. The
name of the selected function and its page number appear in the top-left corner of the
display.
Button Pages
EFFECT 1 Effect1 Edit, Effect1 Library, Effect1 Pre/Post
EFFECT 2 Effect2 Edit, Effect2 Library, Effect2 Pre/Post
Option In Meter, Channel Control, Option Out Meter, Option Out
OPTION I/O
Select, Input Swap
REMOTE Internal Parameter, MMC Control, User Define
AUX 1 Pre/Post, Aux 1-2 Pan
AUX 2 Pre/Post, Aux 1-2 Pan
AUX 3 Pre/Post, Aux 3-4 Pan
AUX 4 Pre/Post, Aux 3-4 Pan
Input Meter, Rtn/Output Meter, Omni Out Meter, St Out Meter,
HOME
Metering Point
01V—Owner’s Manual
18 Chapter 3—Touring the 01V
5
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13/14 15/16 STEREO 1 RETURN 2
17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 MASTER
SEL SEL SEL SEL SEL SEL SEL SEL SEL SEL SEL SEL SEL SEL SEL SEL SEL SOLO
1 6
SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO
2
ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON
6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 0
–5
0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 –10
–15
4 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5
–20
10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10
–30
20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 –40
–50
40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40
60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 –70
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
– ∞
A SEL buttons
The [SEL] buttons are used to select channels for parameter editing: input channels 1
through 24, effects returns 1 and 2, aux sends 1 through 4, effects sends 1 and 2, and the
stereo output. Press [SEL] button 13/14 or 15/16 repeatedly to select input channels 13
and 14 or 15 and 16, respectively. Since most functions on input channels 13 and 14
(likewise 15 and 16) are linked together, the only time you’ll need to select either chan-
nel 13 or channel 14 (likewise 15 or 16) is to set the Phase or Pan for a channel individ-
ually. The number of the selected channel appears in the lower-right corner of the
display. See “Display” on page 28 for more information.
Normally, [SEL] buttons 1 through 8 select channels 1 through 8. When the [OPTION
I/O] button is pressed, however, they select input channels 17 through 24, which are
only available when an Option I/O card is installed. See “SEL Buttons” on page 32 for
more information. The [SEL] buttons 1 through 6 are also used to transmit MMC
(MIDI Machine Control) Locate commands when REMOTE page 2 is displayed.
Finally, [SEL] buttons are also used to make and break channel pairs (“Pairing Input
Channels” on page 52) and fader and mute groups (“Grouping Faders” on page 55 and
“Grouping Mutes” on page 56).
B SOLO buttons
The [SOLO] buttons are used to solo channels: input channels 1 through 16 and effects
returns 1 and 2. Normally, [SOLO] buttons 1 through 8 select channels 1 through 8.
When the [OPTION I/O] button is pressed, however, they select input channels 17
through 24, which are only available when an Option I/O card is installed. See “Solo
Buttons” on page 33 for more information.
The [SOLO] buttons 1 through 16 can also be used as MIDI controllers on REMOTE
page 3. See “User Defined MIDI Controllers” on page 238 for more information.
C ON buttons
The [ON] buttons are used to turn channels on and off: input channels 1 through 24,
effects returns 1 and 2, aux sends 1 through 4, effects sends 1 and 2, and the stereo out-
01V—Owner’s Manual
Top Panel Controls 19
put. Normally, [ON] buttons 1 through 8 select channels 1 through 8. When the
[OPTION I/O] button is pressed, however, they select input channels 17 through 24,
which are only available when an Option I/O card is installed. See “ON Buttons” on
page 34 for more information.
The [ON] buttons 1 through 16 and master can be assigned to various internal param-
eters on REMOTE page 1, or used as MIDI controllers on REMOTE page 3. See
“Assigning Faders & On Buttons” on page 194 and “User Defined MIDI Controllers”
on page 238 for more information.
D Faders
Depending on the selected fader mode, the 01V’s 60 mm motorized faders are used to
control channel levels, aux send levels, or effects sends levels. Normally, faders 1
through 8 control channels 1 through 8. When the [OPTION I/O] button is pressed,
however, they control input channels 17 through 24, which are only available when an
Option I/O card is installed. See “Faders (plus Return Rotary Controls)” on page 35 for
more information.
Faders 1 through 16 and master can be assigned to various internal parameters on
REMOTE page 1, or used as MIDI controllers on REMOTE page 3. See “Assigning Fad-
ers & On Buttons” on page 194 and “User Defined MIDI Controllers” on page 238 for
more information.
E RETURN Controls
The RETURN controls are used to adjust the effects return levels, and their positions
are displayed in the lower-left corner of the display.
F SOLO Status Indicator
The SOLO status indicator lights up when a channel is soloed.
01V—Owner’s Manual
20 Chapter 3—Touring the 01V
Top Panel
INPUT (BAL)
–10dBV (UNBAL)
13 15 L
R
14 16
IN OUT
2TR
PHONES
1 2 34 5
01V—Owner’s Manual
Inputs & Outputs 21
C 2TR IN
These are phono jacks with a –10 dBV nominal input level. Phono plug Tip
Signals input here can be monitored via the monitor out and
phones when the MONITOR–2TR IN switch is set to Sleeve
2TR IN. The stereo outputs of a master recorder can be con-
nected here for confidence monitoring and master playback.
By setting the 15/16–2TR IN switch to 2TR IN, 2TR IN sig-
nals can be fed to input channels 15 and 16 for mixing with
other signals.
D 2TR OUT
These are phono jacks with a –10 dBV nominal output level. Phono plug Tip
The 2TR OUT signal is the same as the stereo out signal. A
cassette deck, DAT, or MiniDisc deck connected here can be Sleeve
used to record the stereo mix.
E PHONES
This is a stereo (TRS) phone jack, to Tip (left)
which a pair of stereo headphones can be 1/4" TRS phone plug Ring (right)
connected for monitoring. The phones
signal is the same as the monitor out sig-
nal, and the level is set using the phones Sleeve (ground)
level control.
01V—Owner’s Manual
22 Chapter 3—Touring the 01V
Rear Panel
1 2 3 4 52 6 7 8
STEREO OUT
MONITOR OUT OMNI OUT R +4dB (BAL) L DIGITAL STEREO MIDI TO HOST
+4dB (BAL) +4dB (BAL)
COAXIAL THRU OUT IN
R L 4 3 2 1 OUT IN
POWER
OPTION I/O
ON/ OFF
9 J
A MONITOR OUT
These are balanced 1/4-inch phone jacks Tip (hot)
with a +4 dB nominal output level. Bal- 1/4" TRS phone plug Ring (cold)
anced or unbalanced phone plugs can be
connected. They output the monitor sig-
nals and should be connected to the inputs Sleeve (ground)
01V—Owner’s Manual
Inputs & Outputs 23
D STEREO OUT
These are balanced XLR-3-32-type 2 (hot)
Female XLR plug 3 (cold)
connectors with a +4 dB nominal
output level. They are wired pin
1–ground, pin 2–hot (+), and pin
3–cold (–). They output the main ste- 1 (ground)
reo mix.
If you need to connect the balanced ST OUT to an unbalanced phone jack input, use a
cable with the following wiring scheme (i.e., XLR pins 3 and 1 linked).
Tip (hot) 2 (hot)
Female XLR plug 3 (cold)
1/4" phone plug
01V—Owner’s Manual
1-6, BUS AUX EFF ST Meter
to +48V Meter L
7-12 1 2 3 4 1 2 3 4 1 2 L R
PHANTOM
24
2TR OUT
Meter
R
INPUT CH Fader
PAN Meter
(BAL) 4-Band
Pad HA AD Dynamics Delay
1-12 PEQ
ON 4-Band Dynamics
ATT AUX1 Delay DA L
PEQ
GAIN AUX2
26dB
BALANCE STEREO
AUX3 ON OUT
01V—Owner’s Manual
AUX4 4-Band
Dynamics Delay DA R
PEQ
EFF1
EFF2 DIGITAL
Dither STEREO
AUX/EFF OUT
PRE/POST
OUTPUT
to OUTPUT
Meter SELECT to
SELECT MONI
L R
CH Fader
Block Diagram
HA AD 4-Band
13 Dynamics Delay
PEQ
INPUT GAIN ON
(BAL) ATT PAN*
DIGITAL
STEREO De-emphasis
ON/OFF to MONI
IN DIGITAL
from STEREO LISTEN ST CASCADE IN
IN
to MONI
Meter
from 2TR IN
Meter
INPUT Meter
1-8 Unchanged STEREO L
(BAL) Unchanged
STEREO R
BUS 1
SWAP Meter
Meter BUS 4
CH Fader PAN AUX 1 Option I/O
Option I/O De-emphasis
17-24 IN 2-Band Output Option Option I/O
or DC Cut from 1-8
PEQ Select Meter I/O OUT
ON AUX 4 Dither
ATT AUX1
CH 1
AUX2 CH 2
Meter
EFF1
CH 15
EFF2 CH 16
This section is available only when
an optional Option I/O card is installed. AUX/EFF
PRE/POST
Meter
EFF RTN
Meter Rotary
4-Band
STEREO L
from EFF1 PEQ
STEREO R
Internal BUS 1
ON PAN*
Effect 1
4-Band BUS 4
PEQ AUX 1 OMNI OUT
AUX1 Select Delay OMNI
from DA
1-4
OUT
AUX2 AUX 4
CH 1
AUX3 CH 2
AUX4
CH 15
EFF2 CH 16
AUX/EFF
PRE/POST
Meter
L
2TR IN LEVEL PHONES
R
25
01V—Owner’s Manual
26 Chapter 3—Touring the 01V
01V—Owner’s Manual
Getting Around the User Interface 27
4
In this chapter...
01V—Owner’s Manual
28 Chapter 4—Getting Around the User Interface
Display
The 320 x 80 dot LCD display provides clear indication of mix settings and operating
status. As well as showing parameter values numerically, faders and rotary controls are
represented graphically, so you can actually see pan and fader positions. The display
also shows EQ curves and signal level meters. The various sections of the display are
explained below.
Page area
Function
Memory
Effects
Returns
Selected channel
01V—Owner’s Manual
Display 29
Memory—This area of the display shows the number and title of the
selected scene memory, whether that scene memory is read only or write
protected (indicated by the closed padlock icon), and whether or not the
contents of the Edit Buffer have been edited. See “Scene Memory Dis-
play Area” on page 185 for more information. Also in the Memory area
are the MIDI and HOST indicators, which appear when MIDI data is
received at the MIDI IN or TO HOST port, respectively. See “MIDI
Receive Indicators” on page 224 for more information.
Effects Returns—This area of the display shows two control icons,
which indicate the positions of the RETURN level controls, and the type
of effects selected for the two onboard effects processors: Effect 1 and
Effect 2. When the EFFECT 1 or EFFECT 2 Fader mode is selected, the
corresponding control icon is highlighted.
Selected channel—This area of the display shows three control icons:
Pan, EQ frequency (F), and EQ gain (G), which indicate the pan, EQ fre-
quency, and EQ gain of the selected channel. Below these is the selected
channel indicator, showing which channel is currently selected. The fol-
lowing channels can be selected.
• CH1 through CH24—Input channels 1 through 24
• ST—Stereo output
• RTN1, RTN2—Effects returns 1 and 2
• AUX1 through AUX4—Aux sends 1 through 4
• EFF1, EFF2—Effects sends 1 and 2
• 1–16, MAS—Remote function channels
When channels 13 through 16, the effects return channels, or paired input
channels from 1 through 12 are selected, dotted lines appear to the right
of these control icons when an odd or left channel is selected. Similarly,
dotted lines appear to the left, as shown here, when an even or right chan-
nel is selected.
Page area—This area of the display is where the various setup, utility, and mixing
function pages appear. As well as showing parameter values numerically, faders and
rotary controls are represented graphically, so you can actually see pan and fader posi-
tions. See “Display Elements” on page 30 for more information. An example page is
shown below.
01V—Owner’s Manual
30 Chapter 4—Getting Around the User Interface
Display Elements
This section explains the various control elements that appear on display pages.
Switches
Switches appear as boxes with a shadowed outline (i.e., a thicker out-
line on the right side and bottom).
The labels inside some switches change when they turned on and
off, as these phase switches show.
To operate a switch, use the cursor buttons to select it, and the [ENTER] button or
[–1/DEC] and [+1/INC] buttons to turn it on or off.
Rotary Controls
Some parameters appear as rotary controls, as this example from
the PANPOT page shows. To adjust a rotary control, use the cursor
buttons to select it and use the PARAMETER wheel or [–1/DEC]
and [+1/INC] buttons to adjust it.
Parameter Boxes
Some parameters appear in parameter boxes
(i.e., dotted-line boxes), as this example from
the EFFECT1 EDIT page shows. To adjust a
parameter box parameter, use the cursor but-
tons to select it, and the PARAMETER wheel or
[–1/DEC] and [+1/INC] buttons to set it.
Parameter boxes that require you to confirm
new settings flash until you press the [ENTER]
button.
Faders
Pages such as VIEW and BUS MASTER display faders graphi-
cally. To adjust a fader, use the cursor buttons to select it, and the
PARAMETER wheel or [–1/DEC] and [+1/INC] buttons to set
it. Fader knobs appear highlighted when set to the nominal posi-
tion. Nominal
01V—Owner’s Manual
Cursor Buttons 31
Cursor Buttons
The cursor buttons are used to move the cursor CURSOR
around the display pages, selecting parameters and
options. The cursor appears as a flashing box, making
it easy to see which parameter or option is currently
selected. Holding down a cursor button moves the
cursor continuously in the respective direction.
PARAMETER Wheel
The PARAMETER wheel is used to adjust parameter values, scroll PARAMETER
through scene memory and library programs, and position the
cursor when titling scene memories, effects programs, and so on.
Its detented action gives it a positive feel, allowing quick and accu-
rate parameter editing. Turning it clockwise increases parameter
values; turning it counterclockwise decreases them.
ENTER Button
The [ENTER] button is used to activate parameter settings selected using ENTER
01V—Owner’s Manual
32 Chapter 4—Getting Around the User Interface
Fader Modes
The 01V [SEL], [SOLO], and [ON] buttons, channel faders, and STEREO (MASTER)
fader are multifunction controls, and their exact operation depends on the selected
Fader mode. Operation of these controls is shown in the following tables.
SEL Buttons
The [SEL] buttons are used to select channels for EQ, Pan, Dynamics, and Routing
operations. The following channels can be selected:
• CH1 through CH24—Input channels 1 through 24
• ST—Stereo output
• RTN1, RTN2—Effects returns 1 and 2
• AUX1 through AUX4—Aux sends 1 through 4
• EFF1, EFF2—Effects sends 1 and 2
• 1–16, MAS—Remote function channels
The [SEL] buttons are also used to make and release channel pairs and fader and mute
groups (“Grouping Faders” on page 55 and “Grouping Mutes” on page 56).
SEL button
Fader Mode 1–8 9–12 13/14 STEREO RETURN 1/2
[17–24] 15/16 [MASTER]
STEREO OUT
HOME
select
AUX 1
AUX 1
master select
AUX 2
AUX 2
master select
AUX 3
AUX 3 CH 1–16 select RETURN 1/2
master select
select
AUX 4
AUX 4
master select
EFFECT 1
EFFECT 1
master select
EFFECT 2
EFFECT 2
master select
01V—Owner’s Manual
Fader Modes 33
channels 13 and 14 (likewise 15 and 16) are linked, the only time you’ll need to select
these channels individually is to set the Phase or Pan. (If a fader mode other than
Option I/O or Remote is selected, it’s not necessary to press the [HOME] button.)
To select the EQ function for input channel 20, press the [OPTION I/O] button, and
then press [SEL] button 20 (CH20 appears on the display). Use the F and G controls to
adjust the EQ.
Master [SEL] Button Examples
To select the stereo output, press the [HOME] button, and then press the MASTER
[SEL] button (ST appears in the bottom right corner of the display).
To select the AUX 1 master, press the [AUX 1] button, and then press the MASTER
[SEL] button (AUX1 appears on the display).
To select the EFFECT 1 master, press the [EFFECT 1] button, and then press the MAS-
TER [SEL] button (EFF1 appears on the display).
Solo Buttons
The [SOLO] buttons are used to solo channels for monitoring. See “Solo Setup” on
page 80 for more information. The following channels can be soloed:
• CH1 through CH24—Input channels 1 through 24
• RTN1, RTN2—Effects returns 1 and 2
SOLO button
Fader Mode 1–8 9–12 13/14 RETURN 1/2
[17–24] 15/16
HOME
AUX 1
AUX 2
RETURN 1/2
AUX 3 CH 1–16 solo
solo
AUX 4
EFFECT 1
EFFECT 2
The [SOLO] buttons 1 through 16 can be used as MIDI controllers on REMOTE page
3. See “User Defined MIDI Controllers” on page 238 for more information.
Usage Examples
To solo input channel 3, press the [HOME] button, and then press [SOLO] button 3.
(If a fader mode other than Option I/O or Remote is selected, it’s not necessary to press
the [HOME] button.)
To solo input channels 13/14, press the [HOME] button, and then press [SOLO] button
13/14. (If a fader mode other than Option I/O or Remote is selected, it’s not necessary
to press the [HOME] button.)
To solo input channel 20, press the [OPTION I/O] button, and then press [SOLO] but-
ton 20.
01V—Owner’s Manual
34 Chapter 4—Getting Around the User Interface
ON Buttons
The [ON] buttons are used to turn channels on or off. They work with the following
channels:
• CH1 through CH24—Input channels 1 through 24
• ST—Stereo output
• RTN1, RTN2—Effects returns 1 and 2
• AUX1 through AUX4—Aux sends 1 through 4
• EFF1, EFF2—Effects sends 1 and 2
The bus outs can be turned on or off on PAN/ROUT page 4.
ON button
Fader Mode 1–8 9–12 13/14 STEREO RETURN 1/2
[17–24] 15/16 [MASTER]
STEREO OUT
HOME
On/Off
AUX 1
AUX 1
master On/Off
AUX 2
AUX 2
master On/Off
AUX 3
AUX 3 CH 1–16 On/Off
master On/Off RETURN 1/2
AUX 4 On/Off
AUX 4
master On/Off
EFFECT 1
EFFECT 1
master On/Off
EFFECT 2
EFFECT 2
master On/Off
01V—Owner’s Manual
Fader Modes 35
To turn on or off the AUX 1 send master, press the [AUX 1] button, and then use the
MASTER [ON] button.
To turn on or off the EFFECT 1 send master, press the [EFFECT 1] button, and then
use the MASTER [ON] button.
01V—Owner’s Manual
36 Chapter 4—Getting Around the User Interface
To adjust the aux 1 send level of input channel 13/14, press the [AUX 1] button, and
then operate fader 13/14.
To adjust the aux 1 send level of input channel 20, use the [OPTION I/O] button to
locate OPTION page 2, press [SEL] button 20, use the cursor buttons to select the
AUX 1 fader, and then adjust it using the PARAMETER wheel or [–1/DEC] and
[+1/INC] buttons.
Note: Aux send levels for input channels 17 through 24 can only be set using the virtual
faders on OPTION page 2.
Input Channel Effects Send Examples
To adjust the Effect 1 send level of input channel 3, press the [EFFECT 1] button, and
then operate fader 3.
To adjust the Effect 1 send level of input channel 13/14, press the [EFFECT 1] button,
and then operate fader 13/14.
To adjust the Effect 1 send level of input channel 20, use the [OPTION I/O] button to
locate OPTION page 2, press [SEL] button 20, use the cursor buttons to select the
EFFECT 1 fader, and then adjust it using the PARAMETER wheel or [–1/DEC] and
[+1/INC] buttons.
Note: Effects send levels for input channels 17 through 24 can only be set using the
virtual faders on OPTION page 2.
Master Level Examples
To adjust the level of stereo out, press the [HOME] button, and then operate the MAS-
TER fader.
To adjust the AUX 1 master send level, press the [AUX 1] button, and then operate the
MASTER fader.
To adjust the EFFECT 1 master send level, press the [EFFECT 1] button, and then
operate the MASTER fader.
To adjust the BUS OUT 1 master send level, use the [PAN/ROUT] button to locate
PAN/ROUT page 3, use the cursor buttons to select the BUS 1 fader, and then adjust it
using the PARAMETER wheel or [–1/DEC] and [+1/INC] buttons.
Note: Bus out master levels can only be set using the virtual faders on PAN/ROUT
page 3.
01V—Owner’s Manual
Title Edit Dialog Box 37
1. Use the cursor buttons to position the cursor in the title window.
2. Use the PARAMETER wheel to select characters.
3. Use the cursor buttons to select the following switches, and press the
[ENTER] button to execute their functions.
INS—Insert a space at the cursor position and moves subsequent characters to the
right. Characters moved beyond the right edge of the title window are lost.
DEL—Delete the character at the cursor position and move subsequent characters to
the left.
4. Use the [+1/INC] button to enter a space at the cursor position.
5. Use the [–1/DEC] button to toggle the character at the cursor position
between uppercase, lowercase, and numerals.
6. Press the [ENTER] button to store.
01V—Owner’s Manual
38 Chapter 4—Getting Around the User Interface
01V—Owner’s Manual
Input Channels 39
Input Channels
5
In this chapter...
01V—Owner’s Manual
40 Chapter 5—Input Channels
01V—Owner’s Manual
Phantom Powering 41
Phantom Powering
CH 1-6 Input channels 1 through 12 feature +48 V phantom powering for use with
ON OFF condenser-type microphones. Phantom powering is supplied to the bal-
anced XLR-3-31-type connector, and can be switched for inputs 1 through 6
and inputs 7 through 12. Phantom powering should be turned on only when
CH 7-12 a condenser-type microphone is connected.
ON OFF
Warning: Make sure that phantom powering is turned off when connecting an unbal-
anced source to an XLR input.
Pad Switches
Input channels 1 through 12 feature 26 dB pad switches. Input pads attenu-
26dB ate the input signal by 26 dB, allowing the input preamp to work with
high-level signals. You may need to use a pad with “hot” signals from bass or
snare drum microphones, or “hot” line-level signals. PAD switch settings are
not stored in scene memories.
01V—Owner’s Manual
42 Chapter 5—Input Channels
Reversed phase
The Phase switches on input channels 13 and 14 (likewise 15 and 16) are not linked, and
can be set independently. When input channels 1 through 12 are paired (“Pairing Input
Channels” on page 52), their Phase switches continue to work independently.
Input channels 17 through 24 do not have Phase switches.
01V—Owner’s Manual
Attenuating Input Channel Signals 43
3. Use the cursor buttons to select the ATT control, and the PARAMETER
wheel or [–1/DEC] and [+1/INC] buttons to adjust it.
01V—Owner’s Manual
44 Chapter 5—Input Channels
01V—Owner’s Manual
Delaying Channel Signals 45
The Channel Delays on input channels 13 and 14 (likewise 15 and 16) are permanently
linked. When input channels 1 through 12 are paired (“Pairing Input Channels” on
page 52), their Channel Delays are linked, so adjustments can be made with either
channel selected.
01V—Owner’s Manual
46 Chapter 5—Input Channels
01V—Owner’s Manual
Panning Input Channels 47
G LOW
SELECTED CHANNEL
Panpots can be adjusted on this page by using the PARAMETER wheel or [–1/DEC]
and [+1/INC] buttons. In addition to the [SEL] buttons, panpots on the PAN/ROUT
page can be selected using the cursor buttons.
01V—Owner’s Manual
48 Chapter 5—Input Channels
Panpots can also be adjusted on this page by using the cursor buttons to select the PAN
control and the PARAMETER wheel or [–1/DEC] and [+1/INC] buttons to set it.
Including center, there are 33 pan positions.
With both controls set at CENTER, as shown here, the width of the stereo
signal is zero (i.e., mono).
Setting the controls to positions in between these two extremes allows you
to set the width of the stereo signal. To maintain a central balance, however,
you must set both controls to corresponding values. For example, L8 and
R8, or L10 and R10.
Pan Modes
The three Pan modes, INDIVIDUAL, GANG, and INV. GANG, determine how the
panpots operate on input channels 13/14, 15/16 (and the effects returns), and paired
input channels 1 through 12. Since input channels 17 through 24 cannot be paired, they
are not affected by the Pan modes.
1. Use the cursor buttons to select the MODE parameter, and the PARAM-
ETER wheel or [–1/DEC] and [+1/INC] buttons to select a mode.
INV. GANG—In this mode, panpots are ganged together but operation is
inverted (i.e., panpots move in opposite directions).
01V—Owner’s Manual
Routing Input Channels 49
Input channels 13 through 24 (and the effects returns) have four bus out rout-
ing switches (1, 2, 3, 4) and a stereo out routing switch (ST).
Routing switches work in conjunction with Panpots to feed signals through to the left
and right channels of the stereo out and the odd and even bus outs. The following table
01V—Owner’s Manual
50 Chapter 5—Input Channels
Signals are fed equally to bus outs 1 and 2 and the left and right
channels of the stereo out.
Signals are fed to bus out 1 and the left channel of the stereo
out.
Signals are fed to bus out 2 and the right channel of the stereo
out.
The Routing switches on input channels 13 and 14 (likewise 15 and 16) are perma-
nently linked. When input channels 1 through 12 are paired (“Pairing Input Channels”
on page 52), their Routing switches are not linked.
01V—Owner’s Manual
Swapping Inputs 1–8 & 17–24 51
2. Use the cursor buttons to select the GLOBAL or individual SWAP switches,
and the [ENTER] button, PARAMETER wheel, or [–1/DEC] and [+1/INC]
buttons to set them.
Swap switches appear highlighted when channels are swapped.
When channels are swapped, their meter numbers appear highlighted on HOME page
1 and OPTION page 1, as shown below. When a swapped channel is selected, the
selected channel area of the display alternately shows the channel number and “SWAP”,
also shown below.
01V—Owner’s Manual
52 Chapter 5—Input Channels
01V—Owner’s Manual
Pairing Input Channels 53
01V—Owner’s Manual
54
01V—Owner’s Manual
BUS AUX EFF ST
1 2 3 4 1 2 3 4 1 2 L R
CH INPUT 1, 3...11 Meter
(odd channels) CH Fader
Chapter 5—Input Channels
4-Band Delay
Unchanged Dynamics
PEQ
PAN*
ATT ON
AUX1
CH INPUT 2, 4...12 Meter AUX2
(even channels) CH Fader EFF1
4-Band EFF2
Unchanged Dynamics Delay
PEQ
Input Channel Pair Block Diagram
AUX/EFF
PRE/POST
Grouping Faders
Input channel faders 1 through 16 can be grouped together in fader groups for
multi-channel control using a single fader. Three groups are available: A, B, and C.
2. Use the up and down cursor buttons to select the fader groups, and the
[SEL] buttons to add and remove faders to and from that group.
Channels cannot be in more than one group at a time.
Input channels 13/14, 15/16, and paired input channels 1 through 12 (“Pairing Input
Channels” on page 52) are added and removed together.
Operate only one fader in a group at a time. If you attempt to adjust two or more faders
in the same group, the fader motors may malfunction due to the increased load.
01V—Owner’s Manual
56 Chapter 5—Input Channels
Grouping Mutes
Input channel [ON] buttons 1 through 16 can be grouped together in mute groups for
multi-channel control using a single button. Three groups are available: D, E, and F.
Mute groups may contain on channels and off channels, making it easy to toggle
between channels. When switched, on channels go off and off channels come on.
2. Use the up and down cursor buttons to select the mute groups, and the
[SEL] buttons to add and remove channels to and from that group.
Channels cannot be in more than one group at a time.
Input channels 13/14, 15/16, and paired input channels 1 through 12 (“Pairing Input
Channels” on page 52) are added and removed together.
01V—Owner’s Manual
Viewing Input Channel Settings 57
VIEW pages for input channels 13/14 and 15/16 appear as below.
01V—Owner’s Manual
58 Chapter 5—Input Channels
01V—Owner’s Manual
Copying & Swapping Channel Settings 59
2. Use the cursor buttons and PARAMETER wheel to select the SOURCE and
DESTINATION channels.
3. Use the cursor buttons and [ENTER] button to select a CATEGORY.
ALL—All input channel settings.
EQ—EQ settings.
DELAY—Delay settings.
DYNAMICS—Dynamics settings.
FADER—Fader settings.
4. Use the cursor buttons to select COPY or SWAP, and the [ENTER] button
to execute the function.
01V—Owner’s Manual
60 Chapter 5—Input Channels
GAIN AUX2
26dB
AUX3
AUX4
EFF1
EFF2
AUX/EFF
PRE/POST
OUTPUT
to
Meter SELECT
Meter
CH Fader
HA AD 4-Band
13 Dynamics Delay
PEQ
INPUT GAIN ON
(BAL) ATT PAN*
HA AD 4-Band
14 Dynamics Delay
PEQ
AUX1
AUX2
AUX3
AUX4
EFF1
FLIP
EFF2
AUX/EFF
PRE/POST
OUTPUT
to
SELECT
Pad
DIGITAL
STEREO De-emphasis
ON/OFF to MONI
IN
Pad
to MONI
Meter
HA 4-Band
15 AD Same as INPUT 13
PEQ
INPUT GAIN 15/16
(BAL) 2TR IN ATT
HA 4-Band
16 AD Same as INPUT 14
PEQ
from 2TR IN
Meter
INPUT
1-8 Unchanged
(BAL) Unchanged
SWAP
Meter
CH Fader PAN
Option I/O De-emphasis
17-24 IN 2-Band
or DC Cut
PEQ
ON
ATT AUX1
AUX2
EFF1
EFF2
This section is available only when
an optional Option I/O card is installed. AUX/EFF
PRE/POST
01V—Owner’s Manual
EQ 61
EQ
6
In this chapter...
01V—Owner’s Manual
62 Chapter 6—EQ
The EQ parameters and response curve for input channels 17 through 24 appear on the
OPTION page shown below.
The quickest way to adjust the EQ is by using the SELECTED CHANNEL controls
shown below.
EQ HIGH
PAN
HI-MID
F
LO-MID
G LOW
SELECTED CHANNEL
01V—Owner’s Manual
Adjusting the EQ 63
Adjusting the EQ
EQ can be adjusted using the SELECTED CHANNEL controls, the quickest method, or
the EQ pages in conjunction with the cursor buttons, [–/DEC] and [+/INC] buttons,
and PARAMETER wheel.
EQ HIGH
PAN
HI-MID
F
The EQ can also be adjusted on this page by using the cursor buttons to select param-
eters and the PARAMETER wheel or [–1/DEC] and [+1/INC] buttons to set them.
01V—Owner’s Manual
64 Chapter 6—EQ
The EQ can also be adjusted on this page by using the cursor buttons to select param-
eters and the PARAMETER wheel or [–1/DEC] and [+1/INC] buttons to set them.
The EQ can also be adjusted on this page by using the cursor buttons to select param-
eters and the PARAMETER wheel or [–1/DEC] and [+1/INC] buttons to set them.
The EQ can also be adjusted on this page by using the cursor buttons to select param-
eters and the PARAMETER wheel or [–1/DEC] and [+1/INC] buttons to set them.
When aux sends are paired (“Pairing Aux Sends” on page 101), their EQs are linked.
01V—Owner’s Manual
Adjusting the EQ 65
The EQ can also be adjusted on this page by using the cursor buttons to select param-
eters and the PARAMETER wheel or [–1/DEC] and [+1/INC] buttons to set them.
01V—Owner’s Manual
66 Chapter 6—EQ
EQ Specs
The following table contains the EQ specs.
Low Lo-Mid1 Hi-Mid1 High
Gain (G) –18.0 dB to +18.0 dB (0.5 dB steps)2
Frequency (F) 21 Hz–20.1 kHz (1/12 octave steps, 120 steps)
HPF, 10.0–0.10 LPF, 10.0–0.10
Q (41 steps), 10.0–0.10 (41 steps) (41 steps),
L.SHELF H.SHELF
1. Four-band EQs only (low and high bands only on input channels 17 through 24).
2. When the low and high EQ bands are configured as HPF and LPF, their gain controls
function as filter on and off switches.
Bypassing the EQ
The selected channel’s EQ can be turned on or off using the EQ ON switch on
the EQ page (OPTION page 2 for channels 17 through 24), or the [ENTER]
button. While the EQ page is displayed, the [ENTER] button turns the EQ on
ENTER
or off regardless of the cursor position.
Resetting the EQ
To reset all the EQ parameters on the selected channel to their initial values, press the
[HIGH] and [LOW] buttons simultaneously.
The following table contains the initial EQ values.
Low Lo-Mid1 Hi-Mid1 High
Gain (G) 0 dB 0 dB 0 dB 0 dB
Frequency (F) 125 Hz 1.00 kHz 4.00 kHz 10.0 kHz
Q L.SHELF 0.70 0.70 H.SHELF
1. Four-band EQs only (low and high bands only on input channels 17 through 24).
01V—Owner’s Manual
EQ Library 67
EQ Library
EQ settings can be stored as programs in the EQ library, which contains 40 preset pro-
grams (1–40) and 40 user programs (41–80). User programs allow you to store fre-
quently used EQ settings, and they can be titled for easy identification. The EQ library
can also be used to transfer settings from one EQ to another. For example, the stereo
out EQ settings could be stored as a library program and then recalled to an aux send
EQ. The unique collection of preset EQ programs are designed for specific applications
and instruments, and provide a good reference and starting point when making EQ
adjustments. See page 71 for a complete list of the preset EQ programs.
The EQ library is controlled from the EQ Library page shown below. Use the [EQ/ATT]
button to locate this page.
As each program is selected, its EQ curve appears in the EQ CURVE window. Above
this are signal level meters for the selected channel.
01V—Owner’s Manual
68 Chapter 6—EQ
Storing EQ Programs
EQ programs are stored on the EQ Library page. You can store EQ settings to user pro-
grams 41 to 80. Preset programs 1 through 40 are read only.
1. Use the [EQ/ATT] button to locate the EQ Library page shown below.
2. Use the [SEL] buttons to select the channel whose EQ settings you want
to store as a program.
You can select input channels 1 through 16, the effects returns, aux sends, or stereo out.
You cannot select input channels 17 through 24.
3. Use the PARAMETER wheel or [–1/DEC] and [+1/INC] buttons to select
programs.
The program list order can be set using the LIBRARY LIST ORDER option in prefer-
ences (“Setting 01V Preferences” on page 203).
4. Use the cursor buttons to select STORE, and then press the [ENTER] but-
ton.
The Title Edit dialog box appears. If the STORE CONFIRMATION option is turned off
in the preferences (“Setting 01V Preferences” on page 203), the Title Edit dialog box
does not appear and the EQ program is stored.
5. Enter a title for the EQ program.
See “Title Edit Dialog Box” on page 37 for more information.
6. When you’ve finished, select OK, and then press the [ENTER] button.
The EQ program is stored.
01V—Owner’s Manual
Recalling EQ Programs 69
Recalling EQ Programs
EQ programs are recalled on the EQ Library page. You can recall any one of the 40 pre-
set and 40 user programs.
1. Use the [EQ/ATT] button to locate the EQ Library page shown below.
2. Use the [SEL] buttons to select the channel to which you want to recall
the EQ program.
You can select input channels 1 through 16, the effects returns, aux sends, or stereo out.
You cannot select input channels 17 through 24.
3. Use the PARAMETER wheel or [–1/DEC] and [+1/INC] buttons to select
programs.
As each program is selected its EQ curve is displayed in the EQ CURVE window.
The program list order can be set using the LIBRARY LIST ORDER option in prefer-
ences (“Setting 01V Preferences” on page 203).
4. Use the cursor buttons to select RECALL, and then press the [ENTER] but-
ton.
The EQ program is recalled. If the RECALL CONFIRMATION option is turned on in
the preferences (“Setting 01V Preferences” on page 203), a confirmation dialog box
appears. In this case, select OK, and then press the [ENTER] button to confirm the
recall.
01V—Owner’s Manual
70 Chapter 6—EQ
01V—Owner’s Manual
Preset EQ Program Parameters 71
01V—Owner’s Manual
72 Chapter 6—EQ
Parameter
# Title Description
LOW L-MID H-MID HIGH
PEAKING PEAKING PEAKING H.SHELF
G +3.5 dB +8.5 dB 0.0 dB 0.0 dB Use on a synth bass with
11 Syn.Bass 1
F 83 Hz 944 Hz 4.00 kHz 12.6 kHz emphasized low range.
Q 0.1 8 4.5 —
PEAKING PEAKING PEAKING H.SHELF
G +2.5 dB 0.0 dB +1.5 dB 0.0 dB Emphasizes the attack
12 Syn.Bass 2 that is peculiar to a
F 125 Hz 177 Hz 1.12 kHz 12.6 kHz synth bass.
Q 1.6 8 2.2 —
L.SHELF PEAKING PEAKING H.SHELF
G –6.0 dB 0.0 dB +2.0 dB +4.0 dB This is used to make a
13 Piano 1
F 94 Hz 944 Hz 3.17 kHz 7.55 kHz piano sound brighter.
Q — 8 0.9 —
PEAKING PEAKING PEAKING H.SHELF Used in conjunction
G +3.5 dB –8.5 dB +1.5 dB +3.0 dB with a compressor, this
14 Piano 2 program emphasizes
F 223 Hz 595 Hz 3.17 kHz 5.33 kHz the attack and low
Q 5.6 10 0.7 — range of a piano sound.
01V—Owner’s Manual
Preset EQ Program Parameters 73
Parameter
# Title Description
LOW L-MID H-MID HIGH
L.SHELF PEAKING PEAKING H.SHELF
A variation on program
G –3.5 dB –2.0 dB 0.0 dB +2.0 dB 20. You can also use it
21 A.G.Stroke 2
F 297 Hz 749 Hz 2.00 kHz 3.56 kHz with a gutsy guitar
sound.
Q — 9 4.5 —
L.SHELF PEAKING PEAKING PEAKING
G –0.5 dB 0.0 dB 0.0 dB +2.0 dB Corrects arpeggio tech-
22 A.G.Arpeg. 1 nique of an acoustic gui-
F 223 Hz 1.00 kHz 4.00 kHz 6.72 kHz tar.
Q — 4.5 4.5 0.12
L.SHELF PEAKING PEAKING H.SHELF
G 0.0 dB –5.5 dB 0.0 dB +4.0 dB A variation on program
23 A.G.Arpeg. 2
F 177 Hz 354 Hz 4.00 kHz 4.23 kHz 22.
Q — 7 4.5 —
PEAKING PEAKING PEAKING PEAKING Use with trumpets,
G –2.0 dB –1.0 dB +1.5 dB +3.0 dB trombones, or sax. With
24 Brass Sec. one instrument, adjust
F 88 Hz 841 Hz 2.11 kHz 4.49 kHz the HIGH or H-MID fre-
Q 2.8 2 0.7 7 quency.
01V—Owner’s Manual
74 Chapter 6—EQ
Parameter
# Title Description
LOW L-MID H-MID HIGH
PEAKING PEAKING PEAKING H.SHELF
G +4.0 dB +1.5 dB +2.0 dB +6.0 dB A variation on program
31 Total EQ 2
F 94 Hz 749 Hz 1.78 kHz 17.9 kHz 30.
Q 7 2.8 5.6 —
L.SHELF PEAKING PEAKING H.SHELF
A variation on program
G +1.5 dB +0.5 dB +2.0 dB +4.0 dB 30. Can also be used
32 Total EQ 3
F 66 Hz 841 Hz 1.88 kHz 15.1 kHz with stereo inputs or
external effect returns.
Q — 0.28 0.7 —
PEAKING PEAKING PEAKING PEAKING
G +3.5 dB –10.0 dB +3.5 dB 0.0 dB A variation on program
33 Bass Drum 3 1. The low and mid
F 118 Hz 315 Hz 4.23 kHz 20.1 kHz range is removed.
Q 2 10 0.4 0.4
L.SHELF PEAKING PEAKING PEAKING
G 0.0 dB +2.0 dB +3.5 dB 0.0 dB A variation on program
34 Snare Drum 3 3. It creates a thick
F 223 Hz 561 Hz 4.23 kHz 4.00 kHz sound.
Q — 4.5 2.8 0.1
L.SHELF PEAKING PEAKING H.SHELF
G –9.0 dB +1.5 dB +2.0 dB 0.0 dB A variation on program
35 Tom-tom 2 5. Emphasizes the mid
F 88 Hz 210 Hz 5.33 kHz 16.9 kHz and high range.
Q — 4.5 1.2 —
PEAKING PEAKING PEAKING H.SHELF
G +4.5 dB –13.0 dB +4.5 dB +2.5 dB A variation on program
36 Piano 3
F 99 Hz 472 Hz 2.37 kHz 10.0 kHz 13.
Q 8 10 9 —
PEAKING PEAKING PEAKING H.SHELF
G –5.5 dB +1.5 dB +6.0 dB 0.0 dB Use for the low range of
37 Piano Low a piano sound recorded
F 187 Hz 397 Hz 6.72 kHz 12.6 kHz in stereo.
Q 10 6.3 2.2 —
PEAKING PEAKING PEAKING PEAKING
G –5.5 dB +1.5 dB +5.0 dB +3.0 dB Use for the high range
38 Piano High of a piano sound
F 187 Hz 397 Hz 6.72 kHz 5.65 kHz recorded in stereo.
Q 10 6.3 2.2 0.1
L.SHELF PEAKING PEAKING H.SHELF
G –1.5 dB –18.0 dB +1.0 dB +3.0 dB Use when recording to
39 Fine-EQ Cass or from cassette tape to
F 74 Hz 1.00 kHz 4.00 kHz 12.6 kHz make the sound clearer.
Q — 4.5 1.8 —
PEAKING PEAKING PEAKING H.SHELF
G –4.0 dB –1.0 dB +2.0 dB 0.0 dB Use when recording
40 Narrator
F 105 Hz 707 Hz 2.52 kHz 10.0 kHz narration.
Q 4 7 0.63 —
01V—Owner’s Manual
Solo, Monitors & Meters 75
7
In this chapter...
01V—Owner’s Manual
76 Chapter 7—Solo, Monitors & Meters
When no channels are soloed, the signal source for the monitor out and phones is
selected using the MONITOR SETUP parameters in the top half of this page. Selectable
sources are: the stereo output, stereo cascade in, aux sends 1 through 4, or bus outs 1
through 4. Signals can be sourced pre-fader (PFL) or post-fader (AFL). Other parame-
ters include monitor trim and a mono/stereo switch. See “Monitor Setup” on page 78
for more information.
The SOLO SETUP parameters in the bottom half of this page are used to configure the
Solo function. Input channels 1 through 24 and the effects returns can be soloed using
the [SOLO] buttons. Two Solo modes are available: Recording Solo and Mixdown Solo.
The SEL MODE determines how signals from each channel are soloed: individually or
mixed together. Signals can be sourced pre-fader (PFL) or post-fader (AFL). Other
parameters include solo trim and a solo enable switch. See “Solo Setup” on page 80 for
more information.
01V—Owner’s Manual
Monitor Outputs 77
Monitor Outputs
Monitor and solo signals are output via the monitor out and phones connections. Make
sure the MONITOR–2TR IN switch is set to MONITOR for monitoring. See
“Two-track Input (2TR IN)” on page 77 for more information.
Monitor signals are converted to analog using 18-bit 8-times MONITOR OUT
oversampling D/A converters, and then output via balanced +4dB(BAL)
PHONES
MONITOR
2TR IN
01V—Owner’s Manual
78 Chapter 7—Solo, Monitors & Meters
Monitor Setup
The signal source for the monitor out and phones is selected using the MONITOR
SETUP parameters on SETUP page 2. Selectable sources are: the stereo output, stereo
cascade in, aux sends 1 through 4, or bus outs 1 through 4. Since the Solo function has
priority, these sources can be monitored only when the Solo function is off (i.e., no
channels are soloed). Signals can be sourced pre-fader (PFL) or post-fader (AFL).
Other parameters include monitor trim and a mono/stereo switch.
1. Use the [SETUP] button to locate SETUP page 2 shown below.
2. Use the cursor buttons to select the MONITOR SETUP parameters, and
the PARAMETER wheel, [–1/DEC] and [+1/INC] buttons, and [ENTER] but-
ton to set them.
SOURCE—These switches are used to select the signal source for the monitor out and
phones. You can select the stereo out, stereo cascade in, aux sends 1 through 4, or bus
outs 1 through 4. Several sources can be selected simultaneously.
LISTEN—This switch sets the monitor signal source to pre-fader (PFL) or post-fader
(AFL). It affects the stereo out, aux send, and bus out monitor sources. For example,
when set to PFL, the stereo out can be monitored regardless of the position of the stereo
master fader. When set to AFL, however, this fader must be raised in order to monitor
the stereo out.
MONI TRIM—This parameter is used to adjust the level of the monitor signal from
–60 dB to +6 dB.
MONO—This switch sets the monitor and phone’s signals to mono (MONO) or ste-
reo (ST). When set to MONO, the left and right signals are summed together to form a
mono mix, which is attenuated by –3 dB.
Using Monitor
To monitor, for example, the stereo out, proceed as follows.
1. Connect a monitoring system (amp, speakers) to the MONITOR OUT.
2. Make sure that the MONITOR–2TR IN switch is set to MONITOR.
3. Set the MONITOR OUT LEVEL control midway.
If you are using headphones, set the PHONES LEVEL control midway.
4. Use the [SETUP] button to locate SETUP page 2, explained previously.
5. Set the SOURCE to STEREO OUT.
If MONITOR SETUP LISTEN is set to AFL, the STEREO fader must be raised. Other-
wise, you won’t hear anything.
01V—Owner’s Manual
Monitor Block Diagram 79
BALANCE STEREO
ON OUT
4-Band
Dynamics Delay DA R
PEQ
DIGITAL
ST
Dither STEREO
OUT
OUTPUT
to
SELECT MONI
L R
Meter Meter
BUS
master fader BUS
OUTPUT
1-4 to
SELECT
ON
1-4
LISTEN
PAN 1-4
1-4
LISTEN
DIGITAL
from STEREO LISTEN ST CASCADE IN
IN
Monitor section
MONITOR
2TR IN
DA
MONI L
TRIM MONO
LEVEL MONITOR
DA OUT
R
to INPUT 15, 16
L
2TR IN LEVEL PHONES
R
01V—Owner’s Manual
80 Chapter 7—Solo, Monitors & Meters
Solo Setup
The Solo function, available on input channels 1 through 24 and the effects returns, is
used to monitor channels individually. Two solo modes are available: Recording Solo
and Mixdown Solo. These and configured using the SOLO SETUP parameters on
SETUP page 2. Solo has priority over the sources selected using the MONITOR SETUP
parameters. Channel signals can be soloed pre-fader (PFL) or post-fader (AFL). When
input channels 1 through 12 are paired (“Pairing Input Channels” on page 52), their
[SOLO] buttons continue to work independently.
1. Use the [SETUP] button to locate SETUP page 2 shown below.
2. Use the cursor buttons to select the MONITOR SETUP parameters, and
the PARAMETER wheel, [–1/DEC] and [+1/INC] buttons, and [ENTER] but-
ton to set them.
SOLO—This switch is used to enable and disable the Solo function. When set to DIS-
ABLE, signals are not soloed, the [SOLO] indicator on the soloed channel lights up
instead of flashing, and the SOLO status indicator does not light up.
SOLO MODE—These switches are used to select the Solo mode: Recording Solo or
Mixdown Solo.
In Recording Solo mode, Soloed channel signals are fed to the Monitor bus and then
output to the monitor out and phones. No other outputs are affected. Input channels
that are turned off can also be soloed. If LISTEN is set to AFL, off channels are moni-
tored PFL. This mode is typically used to monitor individual input signals in recording
and sound reinforcement applications, and is useful for checking whether signals are
clipping, or making EQ adjustments in isolation.
In Mixdown Solo mode, Soloed channels signals are fed to the Stereo bus and then out-
put to the stereo output, monitor out, and phones. Non-soloed channels are muted.
Only channels that are routed to the Stereo bus cab be soloed. For the purpose of solo-
ing, channels that are turned off are turned on when soloed. This mode is typically used
when adjusting individual channels during mixdown.
SEL MODE—These switches set the Solo Select mode. In LAST SOLO mode, only one
channels can be soloed at a time. In MIX SOLO mode, however, several channels can
be soloed simultaneously.
LISTEN—This switches set the solo signal source to pre-fader (PFL) or post-fader
(AFL). It affects input channels 1 through 24 and the effects returns. This switch is not
effective in Mixdown Solo mode because the monitor out and phones signals are
sourced from the Stereo bus. In this mode, the MONITOR SETUP LISTEN switch can
be used to select either PFL or AFL.
SOLO TRIM—This parameter is used to adjust the level of the solo signal from –60 dB
to +6 dB.
01V—Owner’s Manual
Using Solo 81
Using Solo
Input channels 1 through 24 and the effects returns can be soloed as follows.
1. Connect a monitoring system (amp, speakers) to the MONITOR OUT.
2. Make sure that the MONITOR–2TR IN switch is set to MONITOR.
3. Set the MONITOR OUT LEVEL control midway.
If you are using headphones, set the PHONES LEVEL control midway.
4. Use the [SETUP] button to locate SETUP page 2, explained previously, and
configure as necessary.
01V—Owner’s Manual
82
01V—Owner’s Manual
BUS AUX EFF ST
1 2 3 4 1 2 3 4 1 2 L R MONI
L R
LISTEN SOLO
RECORDING SOLO
1-12
Unchanged Unchanged
17-24
ON PAN
LISTEN SOLO
MONITOR
13/14
OUT
15/16 Unchanged ON Unchanged SOLO
TRIM MONO Unchanged
Chapter 7—Solo, Monitors & Meters
EFF1, 2
PHONES
Solo Block Diagram
Meters for input channels 1 through 16 also appear on the VIEW pages. See “Viewing
Input Channel Settings” on page 57 for more information.
Meters for the effects returns also appear on the EFFECT and VIEW pages. See “Using
the Effects” on page 123 and “Viewing Effects Returns Settings” on page 130. Meters for
the aux sends also appear on the VIEW pages. See “Viewing Aux Send Settings” on page
98 for more information.
01V—Owner’s Manual
84 Chapter 7—Solo, Monitors & Meters
Omni Outs
HOME page 3 displays signal level meters for the four omni outs. The source assigned
to an omni out is displayed below its meters. These assignments are made on
PAN/ROUT page 4. See “Assigning Omni Outs” on page 116 for more information.
Stereo Output
HOME page 4 displays signal level meters for the stereo output. Compared to the main
stereo meters, these have a large scale from –72 dB to CLIP.
Meters for the stereo output also appear on the VIEW pages. See “Viewing Stereo Out-
put Settings” on page 89 for more information.
Peak Hold
The Peak Hold function works with the HOME, OPTION I/O, and main stereo meters.
When it’s turned on, the meter segments lit by the loudest signal peaks remain on, pro-
viding an easy way to check for peak levels.
1. Use the PARAMETER wheel, [–1/DEC] and [+1/INC] buttons, or [ENTER]
button to turn the Peak Hold function on or off.
To reset the Peak Hold function, turn it off and then on again.
01V—Owner’s Manual
Setting the Metering Point 85
2. Use the cursor buttons to select the switches, and the PARAMETER wheel,
[–1/DEC], [+1/INC], and [ENTER] buttons to set them.
INPUT—Used to set the meter source points for input channels 1 through 16 and the
effects returns to either PRE EQ or PRE FADER.
OUTPUT—Used to set the meter source points for the stereo output, aux send, and bus
out meters to either POST EQ or POST ON.
Signal level meters for the Option I/O outputs are displayed on OPTION page 3, as
shown below. The source assigned to each output is displayed below its meter. These
assignments are made on OPTION page 4. See “Assigning Option I/O Digital Outputs”
on page 219 for more information.
01V—Owner’s Manual
86 Chapter 7—Solo, Monitors & Meters
Signal level meters for effects send 2 are displayed on VIEW pages 1 and 2, as shown
below.
01V—Owner’s Manual
Stereo Output 87
Stereo Output
8
In this chapter...
01V—Owner’s Manual
88 Chapter 8—Stereo Output
01V—Owner’s Manual
Metering the Stereo Output 89
3. Use the cursor buttons to select the parameters, and the PARAMETER
wheel, [–1/DEC], [+1/INC], and [ENTER] buttons to set them.
Parameters are explained in the following sections.
01V—Owner’s Manual
90 Chapter 8—Stereo Output
–30
–40
–50
–70
– ∞
STEREO
MASTER
01V—Owner’s Manual
Stereo Output Delay 91
2. Use the cursor buttons to select the delay parameters and the [ENTER]
button, PARAMETER wheel, or [–1/DEC] and [+1/INC] buttons to set
them.
Parameter Range Description
ON/OFF ON/OFF These switches are used to turn on and off the delays.
Delay can be specified in milliseconds, meters, or samples
(“Setting 01V Preferences” on page 203). The maximum
delay in samples is fixed at 13229. The maximum delay in
DELAY 0–300 ms
milliseconds and meters depends on the sampling rate. At
44.1 kHz, for example, it is 300 milliseconds and 102.2
meters, respectively.
01V—Owner’s Manual
92 Chapter 8—Stereo Output
BALANCE STEREO
ON OUT
4-Band
Dynamics Delay DA R
PEQ
ST DIGITAL
Dither STEREO
OUT
OUTPUT
to
SELECT MONI
L R
01V—Owner’s Manual
Aux Sends 93
Aux Sends
9
In this chapter...
01V—Owner’s Manual
94 Chapter 9—Aux Sends
01V—Owner’s Manual
Sending Channel Signals to Aux Sends 95
2. Raise the fader of the channel you want to send to the aux send.
If the aux send is configured post-fader (“Pre-fader/Post-fader Aux Sends” on page 97),
you’ll have to raise the channel’s regular fader as well. To do this, press the [HOME]
button, and then raise the fader.
The aux send controls on input channels 13 and 14 (likewise 15 and 16) are perma-
nently linked. When input channels 1 through 12 are paired (“Pairing Input Channels”
on page 52), their aux send controls are linked.
01V—Owner’s Manual
96 Chapter 9—Aux Sends
2. Turn up the rotary control of the effects return you want to send to the
aux send.
If the aux send is configured post-fader (“Pre-fader/Post-fader Aux Sends” on page 97),
you’ll have to raise the effects returns regular control as well. To do this, press the
[HOME] button, and then turn up the rotary control.
01V—Owner’s Manual
Pre-fader/Post-fader Aux Sends 97
The value below each PRE/POST switch indicates the position of the aux send fader.
The position of the corresponding aux send master fader is displayed at the top of the
page.
2. Use the [SEL] buttons or cursor buttons to select the PRE/POST switches,
and the [ENTER] button, PARAMETER wheel, or [–1/DEC] and [+1/INC]
buttons to set them.
The PRE/POST switches on input channels 13 and 14 (likewise 15 and 16) are perma-
nently linked. When input channels 1 through 12 are paired, or when aux sends are
configured as stereo pairs (“Pairing Input Channels” on page 52), their PRE/POST
switches are linked.
01V—Owner’s Manual
98 Chapter 9—Aux Sends
3. Use the cursor buttons to select the parameters, and the PARAMETER
wheel, [–1/DEC], [+1/INC], and [ENTER] buttons to set them.
Parameters are explained in the following sections.
01V—Owner’s Manual
Setting Aux Send Master Levels 99
–30
–40
–50
–70
– ∞
STEREO
MASTER
The MASTER fader now functions as aux send master level control for the selected aux
send.
2. Use the MASTER fader to set the aux send master level.
The position of the aux send master fader is displayed at the top of the AUX PRE/POST
page.
When aux sends are paired (“Pairing Aux Sends” on page 101), their master faders are
linked.
The aux send master levels can be viewed and adjusted on the VIEW pages. See “View-
ing Aux Send Settings” on page 98 for more information.
01V—Owner’s Manual
100 Chapter 9—Aux Sends
The MASTER [ON] button now functions as aux send master on/off switch for the
selected aux send.
2. Use the MASTER [ON] button to turn the aux send on or off.
When aux sends are paired (“Pairing Aux Sends” on page 101), their on switches are
linked.
The aux send master switches can be viewed and set on the VIEW pages. See “Viewing
Aux Send Settings” on page 98 for more information.
01V—Owner’s Manual
Pairing Aux Sends 101
2. Use the cursor buttons to select aux pair 1/2 or 3/4, and then press the
[ENTER] button.
The following dialog box appears.
01V—Owner’s Manual
102 Chapter 9—Aux Sends
When aux sends are paired (“Making Aux Send Pairs” on page 101), the AUX PAN
pages contain panpots for input channels 1 through 16 and the effects returns, as shown
below.
2. Use the [SEL] buttons or cursor buttons to select the channel panpots,
and the PARAMETER wheel or [–1/DEC] and [+1/INC] buttons to set
them.
For input channels 13/14, 15/16, and the effects returns, press the [SEL] buttons repeat-
edly to select the odd/left and even/right channels.
The INPUT PAN LINK option is used to link aux send panpots to their corresponding
channel panpots. When this option is on, pan settings made on the AUX PAN pages are
reflected on PAN/ROUT page 1 and vice versa. Also, the aux panpots are affected by the
INDIVIDUAL, GANG, and INV. GANG pan modes on PAN/ROUT page 1.
Including center, there are 33 pan positions.
Input channels 13/14 and 15/16 and the effects returns feature dual pan-
pots, with the inner panpots being the odd/left channel pans and the outer
panpots being the even/right channel pans. When working with stereo sig-
nals, these dual panpots can be used to adjust the width of stereo signals, as
shown below.
With the inner control set at L16 and the outer control set at R16, as shown
here, the width of a stereo signal is 100%.
With both controls set at CENTER, as shown here, the width of the stereo
signal is zero (i.e., mono).
01V—Owner’s Manual
Pairing Aux Sends 103
Setting the controls to positions in between these two extremes allows you
to set the width of the stereo signal. To maintain a central balance, however,
you must set both controls to corresponding values. For example, L8 and
R8, or L10 and R10.
01V—Owner’s Manual
104 Chapter 9—Aux Sends
AUX 1
LISTEN
AUX 2
LISTEN
AUX 3
LISTEN
AUX 4
LISTEN
to
MONITOR
01V—Owner’s Manual
Aux send panpots are available on input channels
1 through 16 when aux sends are paired. BUS AUX EFF ST
1 2 3 4 1 2 3 4 1 2 L R
In this diagram, aux sends 1 and 2 are paired.
CH Fader PAN Meter Meter
CH INPUT 1-12 Unchanged DELAY Meter
4-Band Dynamics
AUX1/2 AUX1/2 PAN PEQ AUX 1
Unchanged
AUX 1
LISTEN
AUX3
AUX 1/2
Meter master fader ON
AUX4 Meter
4-Band Dynamics
EFF1 PEQ AUX 2
Unchanged
EFF2 AUX 2
LISTEN
AUX/EFF
CH Fader PRE/POST
CH INPUT 13, 15 Unchanged DELAY
ON
PAN*
Meter Meter AUX 3
master fader Meter
CH INPUT 14, 16 Unchanged DELAY ON
4-Band Dynamics
AUX1/2
PEQ AUX 3
Unchanged
Meter AUX 4
master fader Meter
Unchanged ON
4-Band Dynamics
PEQ AUX 4
Unchanged
4-Band
PEQ AUX 4
LISTEN
ON EFF RTN
EFF1, 2 Unchanged Rotary PAN*
4-Band
PEQ
AUX1/2
AUX1/2 PAN
Stereo Pair Aux Send Block Diagram
AUX3
Unchanged
01V—Owner’s Manual
106 Chapter 9—Aux Sends
01V—Owner’s Manual
Bus Outs 107
Bus Outs
10
In this chapter...
01V—Owner’s Manual
108 Chapter 10—Bus Outs
01V—Owner’s Manual
Setting Bus Out Master Levels 109
2. Use the cursor buttons to select the bus out master faders, and the
PARAMETER wheel or [–1/DEC] and [+1/INC] buttons to set them.
When bus outs are paired (“Pairing Bus Outs” on page 111), their master faders are
linked.
Bus out master levels can be controlled using regular faders on REMOTE page 1. See
“Assigning Faders & On Buttons” on page 194 for more information.
2. Use the cursor buttons to select the bus out ON switches, and the [ENTER]
button, PARAMETER wheel, or [–1/DEC] and [+1/INC] buttons to set
them.
When bus outs are paired (“Pairing Bus Outs” on page 111), their ON switches are
linked.
Bus outs can be muted using regular [ON] buttons on REMOTE page 1. See “Assigning
Faders & On Buttons” on page 194 for more information.
01V—Owner’s Manual
110 Chapter 10—Bus Outs
2. Use the cursor buttons to select the TO ST switches, and the [ENTER] but-
ton, PARAMETER wheel, or [–1/DEC] and [+1/INC] buttons to turn them
on.
3. Use the cursor buttons to select the panpots, and the PARAMETER wheel
or [–1/DEC] and [+1/INC] buttons to set them.
Including center, there are 33 pan positions.
01V—Owner’s Manual
Pairing Bus Outs 111
2. Use the cursor buttons to select bus pair 1/2 or 3/4, and then press the
[ENTER] button.
The following dialog box appears.
01V—Owner’s Manual
112 Chapter 10—Bus Outs
MONI
L R
Meter Meter
BUS 1
master fader
BUS 1 OUTPUT
to
SELECT
ON
BUS 1
LISTEN
PAN TO ST
Meter Meter
BUS 2
master fader
BUS 2 OUTPUT
to
SELECT
ON
BUS 2
LISTEN
PAN TO ST
Meter Meter
BUS 3
master fader
BUS 3 OUTPUT
to
SELECT
ON
BUS 3
LISTEN
PAN TO ST
Meter Meter
BUS 4
master fader
BUS 4 OUTPUT
to
SELECT
ON
BUS 4
LISTEN
PAN TO ST
to
MONITOR
01V—Owner’s Manual
Stereo Pair Bus Out Block Diagram 113
BUS 1
Unchanged
BUS 1
LISTEN
TO ST
PAN BUS 2 ON Meter
Meter master fader
BUS 2
Unchanged
BUS 2
LISTEN
TO ST
PAN BUS 3
Meter master fader Meter
BUS 3
Unchanged
BUS 3
LISTEN
TO ST
PAN BUS 4 ON Meter
Meter master fader
BUS 4
Unchanged
BUS 4
LISTEN
TO ST
PAN
01V—Owner’s Manual
114 Chapter 10—Bus Outs
01V—Owner’s Manual
Omni Outs 115
Omni Outs
11
In this chapter...
01V—Owner’s Manual
116 Chapter 11—Omni Outs
Omni Outs
Omni out signals are converted to analog OMNI OUT
using 18-bit D/A converters, and then output +4dB (BAL)
2. Use the cursor buttons to select the OMNI OUT parameter boxes, and
the PARAMETER wheel or [–1/DEC] and [+1/INC] buttons to select
sources for the omni outs.
3. Press the [ENTER] button to confirm your selection.
01V—Owner’s Manual
Omni Out Delay 117
2. Use the cursor buttons to select the delay parameters and the [ENTER]
button, PARAMETER wheel, or [–1/DEC] and [+1/INC] buttons to set
them.
Parameter Range Description
ON/OFF ON/OFF These switches are used to turn on and off the delays.
Delay can be specified in milliseconds, meters, or samples
(“Setting 01V Preferences” on page 203). The maximum
delay in samples is fixed at 13229. The maximum delay in
DELAY 0–300 ms
milliseconds and meters depends on the sampling rate. At
44.1 kHz, for example, it is 300 milliseconds and 102.2
meters, respectively.
01V—Owner’s Manual
118 Chapter 11—Omni Outs
STEREO L
STEREO R
BUS 1
BUS 4
AUX 1 OMNI OUT
from Select Delay DA OMNI
1-4
OUT
AUX 4
CH 1
CH 2
CH 15
CH 16
01V—Owner’s Manual
Effects 119
Effects
12
In this chapter...
01V—Owner’s Manual
120 Chapter 12—Effects
The title of the selected program and the type of effect it uses appear at the top of the
page. Below these are the effects parameters, the number of which vary depending on
the type of effect selected. The type of effect is displayed above the effects returns level
control icons. On this page, Effect 1 is using a HALL reverb, while Effect 2 is using a
CHORUS effect. Up and down arrow icons, like the down icon on this page, indicate
that more parameters are available and can be selected using the up and down cursor
buttons. The meters indicate effects returns signal levels for the selected effects proces-
sor.
01V—Owner’s Manual
Preset Effects Programs 121
Reverb-type Effects
# Title Type Description
Reverb simulating a large space such as a concert
01 Reverb Hall REVERB HALL
hall.
Reverb simulating the acoustics of a smaller space
02 Reverb Room REVERB ROOM
(room) than REVERB HALL.
03 Reverb Stage REVERB STAGE Reverb designed with vocals in mind.
Simulation of a metal-plate reverb unit, producing a
04 Reverb Plate REVERB PLATE
feeling of hard-edged reverberation.
An effect which isolates only the early reflection (ER)
05 Early Ref. EARLY REF. component from reverberation. A flashier effect than
reverb is produced.
06 Gate Reverb GATE REVERB A type of ER designed for use as gated reverb.
07 Reverse Gate REVERSE GATE A reverse-playback type ER.
Delays
# Title Type Description
Mono delay with simple operation. Use when you
08 Mono Delay MONO DELAY
don't need to use complex parameter settings.
09 Stereo Delay STEREO DELAY Stereo delay with independent left and right.
10 Mod.delay MOD.DELAY Mono delay with modulation.
11 Delay LCR DELAY LCR Three-tap delay (L, C, R).
Stereo delay with additional parameters for more
12 Echo ECHO detailed control. The signal can be fed back from left
to right, and right to left.
Modulation-type Effects
# Title Type Description
13 Chorus CHORUS Three-phase stereo chorus.
14 Flange FLANGE The well-known flanging effect.
A Yamaha proprietary effect that produces a richer
15 Symphonic SYMPHONIC
and more complex modulation than chorus.
16 Phaser PHASER Stereo phaser with 2–16 stages of phase shift.
An effect which cyclically moves the sound between
17 Auto Pan AUTO PAN
left and right.
18 Tremolo TREMOLO Tremolo
Only one note is pitch-shifted, but a stable effect is
19 HQ.Pitch HQ.PITCH
produced.
Stereo pitch shift with left and right pitches set
20 Dual Pitch DUAL PITCH
independently.
21 Rotary ROTARY Simulation of a rotary speaker.
01V—Owner’s Manual
122 Chapter 12—Effects
Guitar Effects
# Title Type Description
24 Distortion DISTORTION Distortion
25 Amp Simulate AMP SIMULATE Guitar Amp Simulator
Dynamic Effects
# Title Type Description
Dynamically controlled filter. Responds to MIDI Note
26 Dyna.Filter DYNA.FILTER
On velocity when SOURCE set to MIDI.
Dynamically controlled flanger. Responds to MIDI
27 Dyna.Flange DYNA.FLANGE
Note On velocity when SOURCE set to MIDI.
Dynamically controlled phase shifter. Responds to
28 Dyna.Phaser DYNA.PHASER
MIDI Note On velocity when SOURCE set to MIDI.
Combined Effects
# Title Type Description
29 Rev+Chorus REV+CHORUS Reverb and chorus in parallel
30 Rev->Chorus REV->CHORUS Reverb and chorus in series
31 Rev+Flange REV+FLANGE Reverb and flanger in parallel
32 Rev->Flange REV->FLANGE Reverb and flanger in series
33 Rev+Sympho. REV+SYMPHO. Reverb and symphonic in parallel
34 Rev->Sympho. REV->SYMPHO. Reverb and symphonic in series
35 Rev->Pan REV->PAN Reverb and auto-pan in parallel
36 Delay+ER. DELAY+ER. Delay and early reflections in parallel
37 Delay->ER. DELAY->ER. Delay and early reflections in series
38 Delay+Rev DELAY+REV Delay and reverb in parallel
39 Delay->Rev DELAY->REV Delay and reverb in series
40 Dist->Delay DIST->DELAY Distortion and delay in series
Other Effects
# Title Type Description
Three-band parallel filter (24 dB/octave). Easily setup
41 Multi.Filter MULTI.FILTER when used with the Internal Parameter function on
REMOTE page 1 (see page 194).
42 Freeze FREEZE Basic Sampler
01V—Owner’s Manual
Using the Effects 123
01V—Owner’s Manual
124 Chapter 12—Effects
4. Use the cursor buttons to select an EFFECT fader, and the PARAMETER
wheel or [–1/DEC] and [+1/INC] buttons to set the effects send level.
3. Turn up the effects return RETURN level control (i.e., effects send level
control).
This sends the effects return signal to the selected effects processor. The effects return
meters display the level of the effects return signal.
01V—Owner’s Manual
Pre-fader/Post-fader Effects Sends 125
The value below each PRE/POST switch indicates the position of the effects send fader.
The position of the corresponding effects send master fader is displayed at the top of the
page.
To prevent signal loops, effects return 1 can be fed only to Effect 2, and effects return 2
can be fed only to Effect 1. This is why EFFECT1 page 3 does not have a PRE/POST
switch for effect 1, and EFFECT2 page 3 does not have a PRE/POST switch for effect 2.
2. Use the [SEL] buttons or cursor buttons to select the PRE/POST switches,
and the [ENTER] button, PARAMETER wheel, or [–1/DEC] and [+1/INC]
buttons to set them.
The PRE/POST switches on input channels 13 and 14 (likewise 15 and 16) are perma-
nently linked. When input channels 1 through 12 are paired (“Pairing Input Channels”
on page 52), their PRE/POST switches are linked.
01V—Owner’s Manual
126 Chapter 12—Effects
01V—Owner’s Manual
Viewing Effects Send Settings 127
3. Use the cursor buttons to select the parameters, and the PARAMETER
wheel, [–1/DEC], [+1/INC], and [ENTER] buttons to set them.
Parameters are explained in the following sections.
01V—Owner’s Manual
128 Chapter 12—Effects
–30
–40
–50
–70
– ∞
STEREO
MASTER
The MASTER fader now functions as effects send master level control for the selected
effects send.
2. Use the MASTER fader to set the effects send master level.
The position of the effects send master fader is displayed at the top of the EFFECT
PRE/POST page.
The effects send master levels can be viewed and adjusted on the VIEW pages. See
“Viewing Effects Send Settings” on page 127 for more information.
01V—Owner’s Manual
Muting Effects Sends 129
The MASTER [ON] button now functions as effects send master on/off switch for the
selected effects send.
2. Use the MASTER [ON] button to turn the effects send on or off.
The effects send master switches can be viewed and set on the VIEW pages. See “View-
ing Effects Send Settings” on page 127 for more information.
01V—Owner’s Manual
130 Chapter 12—Effects
3. Use the cursor buttons to select the parameters, and the PARAMETER
wheel, [–1/DEC], [+1/INC], and [ENTER] buttons to set them.
Parameters are explained in the following sections.
01V—Owner’s Manual
Setting Effects Returns Levels 131
01V—Owner’s Manual
132 Chapter 12—Effects
Effects Library
Effects settings are stored as programs in the effects library, which contains 42 preset
programs (1–42) and 57 user programs (43–99). User programs are used to store cus-
tom effects settings, which can be titled for easy identification. The effects library can
also be used to transfer settings from one effects processor to another. For example, the
Effect 1 settings could be stored as a library program and then recalled to Effect 2. The
unique collection of preset effects programs is designed for specific applications and
instruments, and provides a good reference and starting point when using the effects
processors. See page 121 for a complete list of the preset effects programs.
The effects library is controlled from the library page shown below. Use the [EFFECT
1] or [EFFECT 2] button to locate it. Although the effects library can be accessed using
either button, the effects library is in fact common to both effects processors. When the
library page is selected using the [EFFECT 1] button, store and recall operations affect
Effect 1. When the library page is selected using the [EFFECT 2] button, store and recall
operations affect Effect 2.
The top half of the library page contains the STORE, RECALL, and TITLE EDIT
switches. Below these is the library window, which can be scrolled using the PARAME-
TER wheel. The “R” icon next to a preset program means read only. The meters indicate
effects returns signal levels for the selected effects processor.
01V—Owner’s Manual
Storing Effects Programs 133
01V—Owner’s Manual
134 Chapter 12—Effects
01V—Owner’s Manual
Editing Effects Program Titles 135
01V—Owner’s Manual
136 Chapter 12—Effects
Editing Effects
Effects programs can be edited, and then stored as user programs.
1. Press the [EFFECT 1] or [EFFECT 2] button to locate EFFECT1 page 1 or
EFFECT2 page 1, depending on which effect you want to edit.
EFFECT1 page 1 is shown below.
2. Use the cursor buttons to select the effects parameters, and the PARAM-
ETER wheel or [–1/DEC] and [+1/INC] buttons to set them.
Up and down arrow icons, like the down icon on this page, indicate that more param-
eters are available and can be selected using the up and down cursor buttons.
Effects parameters, including variable range and description, are listed on page 138.
To store the edited program, see “Storing Effects Programs” on page 133.
01V—Owner’s Manual
Setting Delay, Freq, Note & Tempo Parameters 137
The FREQ. parameter for modulation-type effects can also be set either manually or
automatically. For example, with the TEMPO set to 120 beats per minute and NOTE
set to quarter note, the FREQ. is automatically set to 2.00 hertz, as shown below. With
the TEMPO still at 120 beats per minute, changing the FREQ. to 4.00 hertz would auto-
matically set the NOTE parameter to eighth note. Similarly, changing the NOTE
parameter to sixteenth note would automatically set the FREQ. parameter to 8.00 hertz.
If the TEMPO parameter is changed, the FREQ. parameter is automatically recalcu-
lated.
The TEMPO can be set from 25 to 300 beats per minute, although the range may be
reduced if the FREQ. parameter calculation exceeds the maximum frequency.
The TEMPO parameter can be entered manually or by using the Tap Tempo function.
To use Tap Tempo, select the TAP TEMPO switch, and then press the [ENTER] button
on each beat. The TEMPO is calculated automatically based on the time between each
button press.
Only the DELAY and FREQ. parameters can be controlled by using MIDI Control
Change and System Exclusive Parameter Change messages.
01V—Owner’s Manual
138 Chapter 12—Effects
Effects Parameters
REVERB HALL, REVERB ROOM, REVERB STAGE, REVERB
PLATE
Hall, room, stage, and plate simulations, all with gates.
Parameter Range Description
REV TIME 0.3–99.9 s Reverb time
INI.DLY 0.0–500.0 ms Initial delay before reverb begins
HI.RATIO 0.1–1.0 High-frequency reverb time ratio
LO.RATIO 0.1–2.4 Low-frequency reverb time ratio
DIFF. 0–10 Reverb diffusion (left–right reverb spread)
DENSITY 0–100% Reverb density
E/R DLY 0.0–100.0 ms Delay between early reflections and reverb
Balance of early reflections and reverb (0% = ER,
E/R BAL. 0–100%
100% = reverb)
GATE LVL OFF, –60 to 0 dB Level at which gate kicks in
ATTACK 0–120 ms Gate opening speed
HOLD *1 Gate open time
DECAY *2 Gate closing speed
HPF Thru, 21 Hz–8.0 kHz High-pass filter cutoff frequency
LPF 50 Hz–16.0 kHz, Thru Low-pass filter cutoff frequency
1. 0.02 ms–2.13 s (fs=44.1 kHz), 0.02 ms–1.96 s (fs=48 kHz)
2. 6.0 ms–46.0 s (fs=44.1 kHz), 5.0 ms–42.3 s (fs=48 kHz)
EARLY REF.
Early reflections.
Parameter Range Description
S-Hall, L-Hall,
TYPE Random, Revers, Type of early reflection simulation
Plate, Spring
ROOMSIZE 0.1–20.0 Reflection spacing
Early reflections decay characteristics (0 = dead, 10 =
LIVENESS 0–10
live)
INI.DLY 0.0–500.0 ms Initial delay before reverb begins
DIFF. 0–10 Reverb diffusion (left–right reverb spread)
DENSITY 0–100% Reverb density
ER NUM. 1–19 Number of early reflections
FB GAIN –99 to +99% Feedback gain
HI.RATIO 0.1–1.0 High-frequency feedback ratio
HPF Thru, 21 Hz–8.0 kHz High-pass filter cutoff frequency
LPF 50 Hz–16.0 kHz, Thru Low-pass filter cutoff frequency
01V—Owner’s Manual
Effects Parameters 139
MONO DELAY
Basic repeat delay.
Parameter Range Description
DELAY 0.0–2730.0 ms Delay time
NOTE *1 Used in conjunction with TEMPO to determine DELAY
Feedback gain (plus values for normal-phase
FB.GAIN –99 to +99%
feedback, minus values for reverse-phase feedback)
HI.RATIO 0.1–1.0 High-frequency feedback ratio
HPF Thru, 21 Hz–8.0 kHz High-pass filter cutoff frequency
LPF 50 Hz–16.0 kHz, Thru Low-pass filter cutoff frequency
TEMPO*2 25–300 bps Used in conjunction with NOTE to determine DELAY
01V—Owner’s Manual
140 Chapter 12—Effects
STEREO DELAY
Basic stereo delay.
Parameter Range Description
DELAY L 0.0–1350.0 ms Left channel delay time
*1 Used in conjunction with TEMPO to determine left
NOTE L
channel DELAY
Left channel feedback (plus values for normal-phase
FB.G L –99 to +99%
feedback, minus values for reverse-phase feedback)
DELAY R 0.0–1350.0 ms Right channel delay time
Used in conjunction with TEMPO to determine right
NOTE R *1
channel DELAY
Right channel feedback (plus values for normal-phase
FB.G R –99 to +99%
feedback, minus values for reverse-phase feedback)
HI.RATIO 0.1–1.0 High-frequency feedback ratio
HPF Thru, 21 Hz–8.0 kHz High-pass filter cutoff frequency
LPF 50 Hz–16.0 kHz, Thru Low-pass filter cutoff frequency
Used in conjunction with NOTE L and NOTE R to
TEMPO*2 25–300 bps
determine DELAY
MOD.DELAY
Basic repeat delay with modulation.
Parameter Range Description
DELAY 0.0–2725.0 ms Delay time
DLY NOTE *1 Used in conjunction with TEMPO to determine DELAY
Feedback gain (plus values for normal-phase
FB.GAIN –99 to +99%
feedback, minus values for reverse-phase feedback)
FREQ. 0.05–40.00 Hz Modulation speed
MOD *2 Used in conjunction with TEMPO to determine FREQ
NOTE
DEPTH 0–100% Modulation depth
HI.RATIO 0.1–1.0 High-frequency feedback ratio
HPF Thru, 21 Hz–8.0 kHz High-pass filter cutoff frequency
LPF 50 Hz–16.0 kHz, Thru Low-pass filter cutoff frequency
Used in conjunction with DLY NOTE and MOD NOTE
TEMPO*3 25–300 bps
to determine DELAY and FREQ.
01V—Owner’s Manual
Effects Parameters 141
DELAY LCR
Three-tap delay (left, center, right).
Parameter Range Description
DELAY L 0.0–2730.0 ms Left channel delay time
*1 Used in conjunction with TEMPO to determine DELAY
NOTE L
L
LEVEL L –100 to +100% Left channel delay level
DELAY C 0.0–2730.0 ms Center channel delay time
Used in conjunction with TEMPO to determine DELAY
NOTE C *1
C
LEVEL C –100 to +100% Center channel delay level
DELAY R 0.0–2730.0 ms Right channel delay time
Used in conjunction with TEMPO to determine DELAY
NOTE R *1
R
LEVEL R –100 to +100% Right channel delay level
FB.DLY 0.0–2730.0 ms Feedback delay time
Used in conjunction with TEMPO to determine
NOTE FB *1
FB.DLY
Feedback gain (plus values for normal-phase
FB.GAIN –99 to +99%
feedback, minus values for reverse-phase feedback)
HI.RATIO 0.1–1.0 High-frequency feedback ratio
HPF Thru, 21 Hz–8.0 kHz High-pass filter cutoff frequency
LPF 50 Hz–16.0 kHz, Thru Low-pass filter cutoff frequency
Used in conjunction with NOTE parameters to
TEMPO*2 25–300 bps
determine DELAY L, DELAY C, DELAY R, and FB.DLY
01V—Owner’s Manual
142 Chapter 12—Effects
ECHO
Stereo delay with crossed feedback loop.
Parameter Range Description
DELAY L 0.0–1350.0 ms Left channel delay time
*1 Used in conjunction with TEMPO to determine DELAY
NOTE L
L
Left channel feedback gain (plus values for
FB.G L –99 to +99% normal-phase feedback, minus values for
reverse-phase feedback)
DELAY R 0.0–1350.0 ms Right channel delay time
Used in conjunction with TEMPO to determine DELAY
NOTE R *1
R
Right channel feedback gain (plus values for
FB.G R –99 to +99% normal-phase feedback, minus values for
reverse-phase feedback)
FB.D L 0.0–1350.0 ms Left channel feedback delay time
NOTE FBL *1 Used in conjunction with TEMPO to determine FB.D L
Left to right channel feedback gain (plus values for
L->R FB.G –99 to +99% normal-phase feedback, minus values for
reverse-phase feedback)
FB.D R 0.0–1350.0 ms Right channel feedback delay time
NOTE FBR *1 Used in conjunction with TEMPO to determine FB.D R
Right to left channel feedback gain (plus values for
R->L FB.G –99 to +99% normal-phase feedback, minus values for
reverse-phase feedback)
HI.RATIO 0.1–1.0 High-frequency feedback ratio
HPF Thru, 21 Hz–8.0 kHz High-pass filter cutoff frequency
LPF 50 Hz–16.0 kHz, Thru Low-pass filter cutoff frequency
Used in conjunction with NOTE parameters to
TEMPO*2 25–300 bps
determine DELAY L, DELAY R, FB.D L, and FB.D R
CHORUS
Chorus effect.
Parameter Range Description
FREQ. 0.05–40.00 Hz Modulation speed
NOTE *1 Used in conjunction with TEMPO to determine FREQ.
DEPTH 0–100% Modulation depth
MOD.DLY 0.0–500.0 ms Modulation delay time
WAVE Sine, Tri Modulation waveform
TEMPO*2 25–300 bps Used in conjunction with NOTE to determine FREQ.
1.
2. For more information about the FREQ., NOTE, and TEMPO parameters, see “Setting
Delay, Freq, Note & Tempo Parameters” on page 137.
01V—Owner’s Manual
Effects Parameters 143
FLANGE
Flange effect.
Parameter Range Description
FREQ. 0.05–40.00 Hz Modulation speed
NOTE *1 Used in conjunction with TEMPO to determine FREQ.
DEPTH 0–100% Modulation depth
MOD.DLY 0.0–500.0 ms Modulation delay time
Feedback gain (plus values for normal-phase
FB.GAIN –99 to +99%
feedback, minus values for reverse-phase feedback)
WAVE Sine, Tri Modulation waveform
TEMPO*2 25–300 bps Used in conjunction with NOTE to determine FREQ.
1.
2. For more information about the FREQ., NOTE, and TEMPO parameters, see “Setting
Delay, Freq, Note & Tempo Parameters” on page 137.
SYMPHONIC
Symphonic efect.
Parameter Range Description
FREQ. 0.05–40.00 Hz Modulation speed
NOTE *1 Used in conjunction with TEMPO to determine FREQ.
DEPTH 0–100% Modulation depth
MOD.DLY 0.0–500.0 ms Modulation delay time
WAVE Sine, Tri Modulation waveform
TEMPO*2 25–300 bps Used in conjunction with NOTE to determine FREQ.
1.
2. For more information about the FREQ., NOTE, and TEMPO parameters, see “Setting
Delay, Freq, Note & Tempo Parameters” on page 137.
PHASER
16-stage phaser.
Parameter Range Description
FREQ. 0.05–40.00 Hz Modulation speed
NOTE *1 Used in conjunction with TEMPO to determine FREQ.
DEPTH 0–100% Modulation depth
Feedback gain (plus values for normal-phase
FB.GAIN –99 to +99%
feedback, minus values for reverse-phase feedback)
OFFSET 0–100 Lowest phase-shifted frequency offset
STAGE 2, 4, 8, 10, 12, 14, 16 Number of phase shift stages
TEMPO*2 25–300 bps Used in conjunction with NOTE to determine FREQ.
1.
2. For more information about the FREQ., NOTE, and TEMPO parameters, see “Setting
Delay, Freq, Note & Tempo Parameters” on page 137.
01V—Owner’s Manual
144 Chapter 12—Effects
AUTOPAN
Auto-panner.
Parameter Range Description
FREQ. 0.05–40.00 Hz Modulation speed
NOTE *1 Used in conjunction with TEMPO to determine FREQ.
DEPTH 0–100% Modulation depth
DIR. *2 Panning direction
WAVE Sine, Tri, Square Modulation waveform
TEMPO*3 25–300 bps Used in conjunction with NOTE to determine FREQ.
1.
2. L<->R, L—>R, L<—R, Turn L, Turn R
3. For more information about the FREQ., NOTE, and TEMPO parameters, see “Setting
Delay, Freq, Note & Tempo Parameters” on page 137.
TREMOLO
Tremolo effect.
Parameter Range Description
FREQ. 0.05–40.00 Hz Modulation speed
NOTE *1 Used in conjunction with TEMPO to determine FREQ.
DEPTH 0–100% Modulation depth
WAVE Sine, Tri, Square Modulation waveform
TEMPO*2 25–300 bps Used in conjunction with NOTE to determine FREQ.
1.
2. For more information about the FREQ., NOTE, and TEMPO parameters, see “Setting
Delay, Freq, Note & Tempo Parameters” on page 137.
01V—Owner’s Manual
Effects Parameters 145
DUAL PITCH
Twin-voice pitch shifter.
Parameter Range Description
PITCH L –24 to +24 semitones Left channel pitch shift
FINE L –50 to +50 cents Left channel pitch shift fine
Left channel level (plus values for normal phase,
LEVEL L –100 to +100%
minus values for reverse phase)
PITCH R –24 to +24 semitones Right channel pitch shift
FINE R –50 to +50 cents Right channel pitch shift fine
Right channel level (plus values for normal phase,
LEVEL R –100 to +100%
minus values for reverse phase)
DELAY L 0.0–1000.0 ms Left channel delay time
*1 Used in conjunction with TEMPO to determine DELAY
NOTE L
L
Left channel feedback gain (plus values for
FB.G L –99 to +99% normal-phase feedback, minus values for
reverse-phase feedback)
DELAY R 0.0–1000.0 ms Right channel delay time
Used in conjunction with TEMPO to determine DELAY
NOTE R *1
R
Right channel feedback gain (plus values for
FB.G R –99 to +99% normal-phase feedback, minus values for
reverse-phase feedback)
MODE 1–10 Pitch shift precision
Used in conjunction with NOTE parameters to
TEMPO*2 25–300 bps
determine DELAY L and DELAY R
ROTARY
Rotary speaker simulator.
Parameter Range Description
ROTATE STOP, START Rotation stop, start
SPEED SLOW, FAST Rotation speed (see SLOW and FAST parameters)
DRIVE 0–100 Overdrive level
ACCEL 0–10 Accelation at speed changes
LOW 0–100 Low-frequency filter
HIGH 0–100 High-frequency filter
SLOW 0.05–10.00 Hz SLOW rotation speed
FAST 0.05–10.00 Hz FAST rotation speed
01V—Owner’s Manual
146 Chapter 12—Effects
RING MOD.
Ring modulator.
Parameter Range Description
SOURCE OSC, SELF Modulation source: oscillator or input signal
OSC FREQ 0.0–3000.0 Hz Oscillator frequency
FM FREQ 0.05–40.00 Hz Oscillator frequency modulation speed
*1 Used in conjunction with TEMPO to determine FM
NOTE FM
FREQ
FM DEPTH 0–100% Oscillator frequency modulation depth
Used in conjunction with NOTE FM to determine FM
TEMPO*2 25–300 bps
FREQ
1.
2. For more information about the FM FREQ., NOTE FM, and TEMPO parameters, see
“Setting Delay, Freq, Note & Tempo Parameters” on page 137.
MOD.FILTER
LFO modulation-type filter.
Parameter Range Description
FREQ. 0.05–40.00 Hz Modulation speed
NOTE *1 Used in conjunction with TEMPO to determine FREQ
DEPTH 0–100% Modulation depth
TYPE LPF, HPF, BPF Filter type: low pass, high pass, band pass
OFFSET 0–100 Filter frequency offset
RESO. 0–20 Filter resonance
Left-channel modulation and right-channel
PHASE 0.00–354.38°
modulation phase difference
LEVEL 0–100 Output level
*2 25–300 bps Used in conjunction with NOTE to determine FREQ.
TEMPO
1.
2. For more information about the FREQ., NOTE, and TEMPO parameters, see “Setting
Delay, Freq, Note & Tempo Parameters” on page 137.
DISTORTION
Distortion effect.
Parameter Range Description
DST1, DST2, OVD1,
DST TYPE Distortion type (DST = distortion, OVD = overdrive)
OVD2, CRUNCH
DRIVE 0–100 Distortion drive
MASTER 0–100 Master volume
TONE –10 to +10 Tone
N.GATE 0–20 Noise reduction
01V—Owner’s Manual
Effects Parameters 147
AMP SIMULATE
Guitar Amp Simulator.
Parameter Range Description
AMP TYPE *1 Guitar amp simulation type
DST1, DST2, OVD1,
DST TYPE Distortion type (DST = distortion, OVD = overdrive)
OVD2, CRUNCH
N.GATE 0–20 Noise reduction
DRIVE 0–100 Distortion drive
MASTER 0–100 Master volume
CAB DEP 0–100% Speaker cabinet simulation depth
BASS 0–100 Bass tone control
MIDDLE 0–100 Middle tone control
TREBLE 0–100 High tone control
EQ F 99–8.0 kHz Parametric equalizer frequency
EQ G –12 to +12 dB Parametric equalizer gain
EQ Q 10.0–0.10 Parametric equalizer bandwidth
1. STK-M1, STK-M2, THRASH, MIDBST, CMB-PG, CMB-VR, CMB-DX, CMB-TW, MINI,
FLAT
DYNA.FILTER
Dynamically controlled filter.
Parameter Range Description
SOURCE INPUT, MIDI Control source: input signal or MIDI note on velocity
SENSE 0–100 Sensitivity
TYPE LPF, HPF, BPF Filter type
OFFSET 0–100 Filter frequency offset
RESO. 0–20 Filter resonance
LEVEL 0–100 Output Level
DIR. UP, DOWN Upward or downward frequency change
DECAY *1 Filter frequency change decay speed
1. 6.0 ms–46.0 s (fs=44.1 kHz), 5.0 ms–42.3 s (fs=48 kHz)
DYNA.FLANGE
Dynamically controlled flanger.
Parameter Range Description
SOURCE INPUT, MIDI Control source: input signal or MIDI note on velocity
SENSE 0–100 Sensitivity
Feedback gain (plus values for normal-phase
FB GAIN –99 to +99%
feedback, minus values for reverse-phase feedback)
OFFSET 0–100 Delay time offset
DIR. UP, DOWN Upward or downward frequency change
DECAY *1 Decay speed
1. 6.0 ms–46.0 s (fs=44.1 kHz), 5.0 ms–42.3 s (fs=48 kHz)
01V—Owner’s Manual
148 Chapter 12—Effects
DYNA.PHASER
Dynamically controlled phaser.
Parameter Range Description
SOURCE INPUT, MIDI Control source: input signal or MIDI note on velocity
SENSE 0–100 Sensitivity
Feedback gain (plus values for normal-phase
FB GAIN –99 to +99%
feedback, minus values for reverse-phase feedback)
OFFSET 0–100 Lowest phase-shifted frequency offset
DIR. UP, DOWN Upward or downward frequency change
STAGE 2, 4, 8, 10, 12, 14, 16 Number of phase shift stages
DECAY *1 Decay speed
1. 6.0 ms–46.0 s (fs=44.1 kHz), 5.0 ms–42.3 s (fs=48kHz)
REV+CHORUS
Reverb and chorus effects in parallel.
Parameter Range Description
REV TIME 0.3–99.9 s Reverb time
INI.DLY 0.0–500.0 ms Initial delay before reverb begins
HI.RATIO 0.1–1.0 High-frequency reverb time ratio
DENSITY 0–100% Reverb density
FREQ. 0.05–40.00 Hz Modulation speed
NOTE *1 Used in conjunction with TEMPO to determine FREQ.
DEPTH 0–100% Modulation depth
MOD.DLY 0.0–500.0 ms Modulation delay time
WAVE Sine, Tri Modulation waveform
Reverb and chorus balance (0% = chorus, 100% =
REV/CHO 0–100%
reverb)
HPF Thru, 21 Hz–8.0 kHz High-pass filter cutoff frequency
LPF 50 Hz–16.0 kHz, Thru Low-pass filter cutoff frequency
*2 25–300 bps Used in conjunction with NOTE to determine FREQ.
TEMPO
1.
2. For more information about the FREQ., NOTE, and TEMPO parameters, see “Setting
Delay, Freq, Note & Tempo Parameters” on page 137.
01V—Owner’s Manual
Effects Parameters 149
REV->CHORUS
Reverb and chorus effects in series.
Parameter Range Description
REV TIME 0.3–99.9 s Reverb time
INI.DLY 0.0–500.0 ms Initial delay before reverb begins
HI.RATIO 0.1–1.0 High-frequency reverb time ratio
DENSITY 0–100% Reverb density
FREQ. 0.05–40.00 Hz Modulation speed
NOTE *1 Used in conjunction with TEMPO to determine FREQ.
DEPTH 0–100% Modulation depth
MOD.DLY 0.0–500.0 ms Modulation delay time
WAVE Sine, Tri Modulation waveform
Reverb and chorused reverb balance (0% = chorused
REV BAL. 0–100%
reverb, 100% = reverb)
HPF Thru, 21 Hz–8.0 kHz High-pass filter cutoff frequency
LPF 50 Hz–16.0 kHz, Thru Low-pass filter cutoff frequency
*2 25–300 bps Used in conjunction with NOTE to determine FREQ.
TEMPO
1.
2. For more information about the FREQ., NOTE, and TEMPO parameters, see “Setting
Delay, Freq, Note & Tempo Parameters” on page 137.
REV+FLANGE
Reverb and flanger effects in parallel.
Parameter Range Description
REV TIME 0.3–99.9 s Reverb time
INI.DLY 0.0–500.0 ms Initial delay before reverb begins
HI.RATIO 0.1–1.0 High-frequency reverb time ratio
DENSITY 0–100% Reverb density
FREQ. 0.05–40.00 Hz Modulation speed
NOTE *1 Used in conjunction with TEMPO to determine FREQ.
DEPTH 0–100% Modulation depth
MOD.DLY 0.0–500.0 ms Modulation delay time
Feedback gain (plus values for normal-phase
FB.GAIN –99 to +99%
feedback, minus values for reverse-phase feedback)
WAVE Sine, Tri Modulation waveform
Reverb and flange balance (0% = flange, 100% =
REV/FLG 0–100%
reverb)
HPF Thru, 21 Hz–8.0 kHz High-pass filter cutoff frequency
LPF 50 Hz–16.0 kHz, Thru Low-pass filter cutoff frequency
TEMPO*2 25–300 bps Used in conjunction with NOTE to determine FREQ.
1.
2. For more information about the FREQ., NOTE, and TEMPO parameters, see “Setting
Delay, Freq, Note & Tempo Parameters” on page 137.
01V—Owner’s Manual
150 Chapter 12—Effects
REV->FLANGE
Reverb and flanger effects in series.
Parameter Range Description
REV TIME 0.3–99.9 s Reverb time
INI.DLY 0.0–500.0 ms Initial delay before reverb begins
HI.RATIO 0.1–1.0 High-frequency reverb time ratio
DENSITY 0–100% Reverb density
FREQ. 0.05–40.00 Hz Modulation speed
NOTE *1 Used in conjunction with TEMPO to determine FREQ.
DEPTH 0–100% Modulation depth
MOD.DLY 0.0–500.0 ms Modulation delay time
Feedback gain (plus values for normal-phase
FB.GAIN –99 to +99%
feedback, minus values for reverse-phase feedback)
WAVE Sine, Tri Modulation waveform
Reverb and flanged reverb balance (0% = flanged
REV BAL. 0–100%
reverb, 100% = reverb)
HPF Thru, 21 Hz–8.0 kHz High-pass filter cutoff frequency
LPF 50 Hz–16.0 kHz, Thru Low-pass filter cutoff frequency
TEMPO*2 25–300 bps Used in conjunction with NOTE to determine FREQ.
1.
2. For more information about the FREQ., NOTE, and TEMPO parameters, see “Setting
Delay, Freq, Note & Tempo Parameters” on page 137.
REV+SYMPHO.
Reverb and symphonic effects in parallel.
Parameter Range Description
REV TIME 0.3–99.9 s Reverb time
INI.DLY 0.0–500.0 ms Initial delay before reverb begins
HI.RATIO 0.1–1.0 High-frequency reverb time ratio
DENSITY 0–100% Reverb density
FREQ. 0.05–40.00 Hz Modulation speed
NOTE *1 Used in conjunction with TEMPO to determine FREQ.
DEPTH 0–100% Modulation depth
MOD.DLY 0.0–500.0 ms Modulation delay time
WAVE Sine, Tri Modulation waveform
Reverb and symphonic balance (0% = symphonic,
REV/SYM 0–100%
100% = reverb)
HPF Thru, 21 Hz–8.0 kHz High-pass filter cutoff frequency
LPF 50 Hz–16.0 kHz, Thru Low-pass filter cutoff frequency
TEMPO*2 25–300 bps Used in conjunction with NOTE to determine FREQ.
1.
2. For more information about the FREQ., NOTE, and TEMPO parameters, see “Setting
Delay, Freq, Note & Tempo Parameters” on page 137.
01V—Owner’s Manual
Effects Parameters 151
REV->SYMPHO.
Reverb and symphonic effects in series.
Parameter Range Description
REV TIME 0.3–99.9 s Reverb time
INI.DLY 0.0–500.0 ms Initial delay before reverb begins
HI.RATIO 0.1–1.0 High-frequency reverb time ratio
DENSITY 0–100% Reverb density
FREQ. 0.05–40.00 Hz Modulation speed
NOTE *1 Used in conjunction with TEMPO to determine FREQ.
DEPTH 0–100% Modulation depth
MOD.DLY 0.0–500.0 ms Modulation delay time
WAVE Sine, Tri Modulation waveform
Reverb and symphonic reverb balance (0% =
REV BAL. 0–100%
symphonic reverb, 100% = reverb)
HPF Thru, 21 Hz–8.0 kHz High-pass filter cutoff frequency
LPF 50 Hz–16.0 kHz, Thru Low-pass filter cutoff frequency
*2 25–300 bps Used in conjunction with NOTE to determine FREQ.
TEMPO
1.
2. For more information about the FREQ., NOTE, and TEMPO parameters, see “Setting
Delay, Freq, Note & Tempo Parameters” on page 137.
REV->PAN
Reverb and auto-pan effects in parallel.
Parameter Range Description
REV TIME 0.3–99.9 s Reverb time
INI.DLY 0.0–500.0 ms Initial delay before reverb begins
HI.RATIO 0.1–1.0 High-frequency reverb time ratio
DENSITY 0–100% Reverb density
FREQ. 0.05–40.00 Hz Modulation speed
NOTE *1 Used in conjunction with TEMPO to determine FREQ.
DEPTH 0–100% Modulation depth
DIR. *2 Panning direction
WAVE Sine, Tri, Square Modulation waveform
Reverb and panned reverb balance (0% = panned
REV BAL. 0–100%
reverb, 100% = reverb)
HPF Thru, 21 Hz–8.0 kHz High-pass filter cutoff frequency
50 Hz–16.0 kHz, Thru
LPF Low-pass filter cutoff frequency
Hz
TEMPO*3 25–300 bps Used in conjunction with NOTE to determine FREQ.
1.
2. L<->R, L—>R, L<—R, Turn L, Turn R
3. For more information about the FREQ., NOTE, and TEMPO parameters, see “Setting
Delay, Freq, Note & Tempo Parameters” on page 137.
01V—Owner’s Manual
152 Chapter 12—Effects
DELAY+ER.
Delay and early reflections effects in parallel.
Parameter Range Description
DELAY L 0.0–1000.0 ms Left channel delay time
*1 Used in conjunction with TEMPO to determine left
NOTE L
channel DELAY L
Feedback gain (plus values for normal-phase
FB.GAIN –99 to +99%
feedback, minus values for reverse-phase feedback)
DELAY R 0.0–1000.0 ms Right channel delay time
Used in conjunction with TEMPO to determine right
NOTE R *1
channel DELAY R
HI.RATIO 0.1–1.0 High-frequency feedback ratio
FB.DLY 0.0–1000.0 ms Feedback delay time
Used in conjunction with TEMPO to determine
NOTE FB *1
FB.DLY
Delay and early reflections balance (0% = early
DLY/ER 0–100%
reflections, 100% = delay)
S-Hall, L-Hall,
TYPE Random, Revers, Type of early reflection simulation
Plate, Spring
ROOMSIZE 0.1–20.0 Reflection spacing
Early reflections decay characteristics (0 = dead, 10 =
LIVENESS 0–10
live)
INI.DLY 0.0–500.0 ms Initial delay before reverb begins
DENSITY 0–100% Reverb density
ER NUM. 1–19 Number of early reflections
Used in conjunction with NOTE parameters to
TEMPO*2 25–300 bps
determine DELAY L, DELAY R, and FB.DLY
01V—Owner’s Manual
Effects Parameters 153
DELAY->ER.
Delay and early reflections effects in series.
Parameter Range Description
DELAY L 0.0–1000.0 ms Left channel delay time
*1 Used in conjunction with TEMPO to determine left
NOTE L
channel DELAY L
Feedback gain (plus values for normal-phase
FB.GAIN –99 to +99%
feedback, minus values for reverse-phase feedback)
DELAY R 0.0–1000.0 ms Right channel delay time
Used in conjunction with TEMPO to determine right
NOTE R *1
channel DELAY R
HI.RATIO 0.1–1.0 High-frequency feedback ratio
FB.DLY 0.0–1000.0 ms Feedback delay time
Used in conjunction with TEMPO to determine
NOTE FB *1
FB.DLY
Delay and early reflected delay balance (0% = early
DLY BAL. 0–100%
reflected delay, 100% = delay)
S-Hall, L-Hall,
TYPE Random, Revers, Type of early reflection simulation
Plate, Spring
ROOMSIZE 0.1–20.0 Reflection spacing
Early reflections decay characteristics (0 = dead, 10 =
LIVENESS 0–10
live)
INI.DLY 0.0–500.0 ms Initial delay before reverb begins
DENSITY 0–100% Reverb density
ER NUM. 1–19 Number of early reflections
Used in conjunction with NOTE parameters to
TEMPO*2 25–300 bps
determine DELAY L, DELAY R, and FB.DLY
01V—Owner’s Manual
154 Chapter 12—Effects
DELAY+REV
Delay and reverb effects in parallel.
Parameter Range Description
DELAY L 0.0–1000.0 ms Left channel delay time
*1 Used in conjunction with TEMPO to determine left
NOTE L
channel DELAY L
Feedback gain (plus values for normal-phase
FB.GAIN –99 to +99%
feedback, minus values for reverse-phase feedback)
DELAY R 0.0–1000.0 ms Right channel delay time
Used in conjunction with TEMPO to determine right
NOTE R *1
channel DELAY R
DLY HI 0.1–1.0 Delay high-frequency feedback ratio
FB.DLY 0.0–1000.0 ms Feedback delay time
Used in conjunction with TEMPO to determine
NOTE FB *1
FB.DLY
Delay and reverb balance (0% = reverb, 100% =
DLY/REV 0–100%
delay)
REV TIME 0.3–99.9 s Reverb time
INI.DLY 0.0–500.0 ms Initial delay before reverb begins
REV HI 0.1–1.0 High-frequency reverb time ratio
DENSITY 0–100% Reverb density
HPF Thru, 21 Hz–8.0 kHz High-pass filter cutoff frequency
LPF 50 Hz–16.0 kHz, Thru Low-pass filter cutoff frequency
Used in conjunction with NOTE parameters to
TEMPO*2 25–300 bps
determine DELAY L, DELAY R, and FB.DLY
01V—Owner’s Manual
Effects Parameters 155
DELAY->REV
Delay and reverb effects in series.
Parameter Range Description
DELAY L 0.0–1000.0 ms Left channel delay time
*1 Used in conjunction with TEMPO to determine left
NOTE L
channel DELAY L
Feedback gain (plus values for normal-phase
FB.GAIN –99 to +99%
feedback, minus values for reverse-phase feedback)
DELAY R 0.0–1000.0 ms Right channel delay time
Used in conjunction with TEMPO to determine right
NOTE R *1
channel DELAY R
DLY HI 0.1–1.0 Delay high-frequency feedback ratio
FB.DLY 0.0–1000.0 ms Feedback delay time
Used in conjunction with TEMPO to determine
NOTE FB *1
FB.DLY
Delay and delayed reverb balance (0% = delayed
DLY BAL 0–100%
reverb, 100% = delay)
REV TIME 0.3–99.9 s Reverb time
INI.DLY 0.0–500.0 ms Initial delay before reverb begins
REV HI 0.1–1.0 High-frequency reverb time ratio
DENSITY 0–100% Reverb density
HPF Thru, 21 Hz–8.0 kHz High-pass filter cutoff frequency
LPF 50 Hz–16.0 kHz, Thru Low-pass filter cutoff frequency
Used in conjunction with NOTE parameters to
TEMPO*2 25–300 bps
determine DELAY L, DELAY R, and FB.DLY
01V—Owner’s Manual
156 Chapter 12—Effects
DIST->DELAY
Distortion and delay effects in series.
Parameter Range Description
DST1, DST2, OVD1,
DST TYPE Distortion type (DST = distortion, OVD = overdrive)
OVD2, CRUNCH
DRIVE 0–100 Distortion drive
MASTER 0–100 Master volume
TONE –10 to +10 Tone control
N.GATE 0–20 Noise reduction
Distortion and delay balance (0% = distortion, 100%
DLY BAL 0–100%
= delayed distortion)
DELAY 0.0–2725.0 ms Delay time
DLY NOTE *1 Used in conjunction with TEMPO to determine DELAY
Feedback gain (plus values for normal-phase
FB.GAIN –99 to +99%
feedback, minus values for reverse-phase feedback)
HI.RATIO 0.1–1.0 High-frequency feedback ratio
FREQ. 0.05–40.00 Hz Modulation speed
MOD *2 Used in conjunction with TEMPO to determine FREQ.
NOTE
DEPTH 0–100% Modulation depth
Used in conjunction with NOTE parameters to
TEMPO*3 25–300 bps
determine DELAY and FREQ.
MULTI FILTER
Three-band parallel filter (24 dB/octave)
Parameter Range Description
TYPE 1 HPF, LPF, BPF Filter 1 type: low pass, high pass, band pass
TYPE 2 HPF, LPF, BPF Filter 2 type: low pass, high pass, band pass
TYPE 3 HPF, LPF, BPF Filter 3 type: low pass, high pass, band pass
FREQ. 1 28 Hz–16.0 kHz Filter 1 frequency
FREQ. 2 28 Hz–16.0 kHz Filter 2 frequency
FREQ. 3 28 Hz–16.0 kHz Filter 3 frequency
LEVEL 1 0–100 Filter 1 level
LEVEL 2 0–100 Filter 2 level
LEVEL 3 0–100 Filter 3 level
RESO. 1 0–20 Filter 1 resonance
RESO. 2 0–20 Filter 2 resonance
RESO. 3 0–20 Filter 3 resonance
01V—Owner’s Manual
Effects Parameters 157
3. Select the (REC) switch, and then press the [ENTER] button. Note
that the previous sampler is deleted at this point.
The REC switch appears highlighted, and input signal can be heard.
01V—Owner’s Manual
158 Chapter 12—Effects
4. Select the (PLAY) switch, and press the [ENTER] button to start
recording.
The bar below the REC and PLAY switches fills up as recording progresses.
With the REC MODE is set to INPUT, recording starts automatically when an input
signal exceeds the TRG LVL.
5. To play back the sample, select the (PLAY) switch, and then press the
[ENTER] button.
With the PLY MODE is set to INPUT, playback starts automatically when an input sig-
nal exceeds the TRG LVL.
Use the PLY MODE parameters to set the type of playback, and the START, END, and
LOOP parameters to edit the sample.
Be aware that samples are lost when another type of effect is recalled or the 01V is
turned off.
01V—Owner’s Manual
Effects Block Diagram 159
ON
Effect send 2
master fader
ON
Meter
EFF RTN 1
Meter Rotary
4-Band
PEQ
Internal
ON PAN*
Effect 1
4-Band
PEQ
AUX1
AUX2
AUX3
AUX4
EFF2
AUX/EFF
PRE/POST
Meter
EFF RTN 2
Meter Rotary
4-Band
PEQ
Internal
ON PAN*
Effect 2
4-Band
PEQ
AUX1
AUX2
AUX3
AUX4
EFF1
AUX/EFF
PRE/POST
01V—Owner’s Manual
160 Chapter 12—Effects
01V—Owner’s Manual
Dynamics Processors 161
Dynamics Processors
13
In this chapter...
01V—Owner’s Manual
162 Chapter 13—Dynamics Processors
The name of the type of dynamics processor appears in the middle of the page next the
dynamics curve. To the left is the processor on/off switch. Below these are the dynamics
parameters, the number of which vary depending on the type of processor selected. The
GR meter indicates the amount of gain reduction being applied to the selected channel.
Next to this are level meters for the selected channel and its neighbor.
01V—Owner’s Manual
Preset Dynamics Programs 163
01V—Owner’s Manual
164 Chapter 13—Dynamics Processors
01V—Owner’s Manual
Using the Dynamics Processors 165
4. Use the cursor buttons to select the parameters, and the PARAMETER
wheel or [–1/DEC] and [+1/INC] buttons to set them.
When aux sends are paired (“Making Aux Send Pairs” on page 101), their dynamics
processors are linked.
01V—Owner’s Manual
166 Chapter 13—Dynamics Processors
01V—Owner’s Manual
Processor Types 167
Processor Types
Dynamics processors are generally used to correct or control signal levels, although
they can also be used creatively to shape a sound’s volume envelope. The following sec-
tions explain the COMP, GATE, DUCKING, EXPAND, COMPANDER-(H), and
COMPANDER-(S) dynamics processors, their parameters, and general applications.
COMP
The COMP processor is a compressor that
attenuates signals above a specified threshold, +20
01V—Owner’s Manual
168 Chapter 13—Dynamics Processors
THRESHOLD—This determines the level of input signal required to trigger the com-
pressor. Signals at a level below the threshold pass through the compressor unaffected.
Signals at and above the threshold level are compressed by the amount specified using
the Ratio parameter. The trigger signal is sourced using the KEY IN parameter.
OUT GAIN—This sets the compressor’s output signal level, and can be used to com-
pensate for the overall level change caused by the compression process.
KNEE—This determines how compression is applied at the threshold point. When set
to hard, compression at the specified ratio is applied as soon as the input signal level
exceeds the specified threshold. For knee settings from 1 to 5, however, compression is
applied gradually as the signal exceeds the specified threshold, creating a more natural
sound. This is called soft-knee compression.
ATTACK—This determines how soon the signal is compressed once the compressor
has been triggered. With a fast attack time, the signal is compressed almost immedi-
ately. With a slow attack time, however, the initial transient of a sound passes through
unaffected. Attack times from 1 to 5 milliseconds are a good place to start.
RELEASE—This determines how soon the compressor returns to its normal gain once
the trigger signal level drops below the threshold. If the release time is too short, the
gain will recover too quickly causing level pumping (i.e., noticeable gain fluctuations).
If it is set too long, the compressor may not have time to recover before the next high
level signal appears, and it will be compressed incorrectly. Release times from 0.1 to 0.5
seconds are a good place to start.
RATIO—This determines the amount of compression, that is, the change in output sig-
nal level relative to change in input signal level. For a 2:1 ratio, for example, a 10 dB
change in input level (above the threshold) results in a 5 dB change in output level. For
a 5:1 ratio, a 10 dB change in input level (above the threshold) results in a 2 dB change
in output level.
GATE
A gate, or noise gate is essentially an audio
switch used to mute signals below a set +20
01V—Owner’s Manual
Processor Types 169
THRESHOLD—This determines the level at which the gate closes, cutting off the sig-
nal. Signals above the threshold level pass through unaffected. Signals at or below the
threshold, however, cause the gate to close. The trigger signal is sourced using the KEY
IN parameter.
RANGE—This determines the level to which the gate closes. Think of it as a brick hold-
ing a garden gate open so that a certain amount of signal always flows through. For a
setting of –70 dB, the gate closes completely when the input signal falls below the
threshold. For a setting of –30 dB, however, the gate half closes. For a setting of 0 dB,
the gate has no effect. When signals are gated abruptly, the sudden disappearance can
sometimes sound odd. This parameter causes the gate to reduce the signal level rather
than cut it completely.
HOLD—This determines how long the gate stays open once the trigger signal has fallen
below the threshold level.
ATTACK—This determines how fast the gate opens when the signal exceeds the thresh-
old level. Slow attack times can be used to remove the initial transient edge of percussive
sounds. Too slow an attack time makes some sounds appear backwards.
DECAY—This determines how fast the gate closes once the hold time has expired. A
longer decay time produces a more natural gating effect, allowing the natural decay of
an instrument to pass through. With a maximum decay time of between 42 and 63 sec-
onds, you could even use this for fade-outs.
DUCKING
Ducking is commonly used for voice-over
applications in which the background music +20
Threshold = –20dB
sound source. For example, a ducker is –20
THRESHOLD—This determines the level of trigger signal (KEY IN) required to acti-
vate ducking. Trigger signal levels below the threshold do not activate ducking. Trigger
signals at and above the threshold level, however, activate ducking, and the signal level
01V—Owner’s Manual
170 Chapter 13—Dynamics Processors
is reduced to a level set by the Range parameter. The trigger signal is sourced using the
KEY IN parameter.
RANGE—This determines the level to which the signal is ducked. For a setting of
–80 dB, the signal is virtually cutoff. For a setting of –30 dB, however, the signal is
ducked by 30 dB. For a setting of 0 dB, the ducker has no effect.
HOLD— This determines how long ducking remains active once the trigger signal has
fallen below the threshold level.
ATTACK—This determines how soon the signal is ducked once the ducker has been
triggered. With a fast attack time, the signal is ducked almost immediately. With a slow
attack time, however, ducking appears to fade the signal. Too fast an attack time may
sound abrupt.
DECAY—This determines how soon the ducker returns to its normal gain once the
trigger signal level drops below the threshold.
EXPAND
An expander is similar to a compressor except that it works on signals below the thresh-
old level. By reducing signals below the threshold level, the expander attenuates
low-level noise, effectively increasing the dynamic range and improving the sig-
nal-to-noise performance. An expander set to an infinite ratio (i.e., ∞:1) is essentially a
gate. The following two graphs show typical expander curves. The one on the left shows
an expander with an expansion ratio of 2:1 and a hard knee setting. The one on the
right shows an expander with an expansion ratio of 2:1 and a soft knee setting of 5.
+20 +20
0 0 Knee = 5
Knee = hard
–10 –10
Output Level (dB)
–20
Threshold = –10dB –20
Threshold = –20dB
–30 –30
–40 –40
–50 –50
–60 –60
–70 –70
–70 –60 –50 –40 –30 –20 –10 0 +10 +20 –70 –60 –50 –40 –30 –20 –10 0 +10 +20
Input Level (dB) Input Level (dB)
Parameter Range
THRESHOLD –54 dB to 0 dB (55 steps)
OUT GAIN 0.0 dB to +18.0 dB (0.5 dB steps)
KNEE hard, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5
ATTACK 0–120 ms (1 ms steps)
5 ms–42.3 s (fs = 48 kHz)
RELEASE
6 ms–46 s (fs = 44.1 kHz)
1:1, 1.1:1, 1.3:1, 1.5:1, 1.7:1, 2:1, 2.5:1, 3:1, 3.5:1, 4:1, 5:1, 6:1, 8:1,
RATIO
10:1, 20:1, ∞:1 (16 steps)
01V—Owner’s Manual
Processor Types 171
OUT GAIN—This sets the expander’s output signal level, and can be used to compen-
sate for the overall level change caused by the expansion process.
KNEE—This determines how expansion is applied at the threshold point. When set to
hard, expansion at the specified ratio is applied as soon as the input signal level falls
below the specified threshold. For knee settings from 1 to 5, however, expansion is
applied gradually as the signal falls below the specified threshold, creating a more nat-
ural sound.
ATTACK—This determines how soon the signal is expanded once the expander has
been triggered. With a fast attack time, the signal is expanded almost immediately. With
a slow attack time, however, the initial transient of a sound passes through unaffected.
Attack times from 1 to 5 milliseconds are a good place to start.
RELEASE—This determines how soon the expander returns to its normal gain once the
trigger signal level exceeds the threshold. If the release time is too short, the gain will
recover too quickly causing level pumping (i.e., noticeable gain fluctuations). If it is set
too long, the expander may not have time to recover before the next low-level signal
appears, and it will be expanded incorrectly. Release times from 0.1 to 0.5 seconds are a
good place to start.
RATIO—This determines the amount of expansion. That is, the change in output sig-
nal level relative to change in input signal level. For a 2:1 ratio, for example, a 5 dB
change in input level (below the threshold) results in a 10 dB change in output level. For
a 5:1 ratio, a 2 dB change in input level (below the threshold) results in a 10 dB change
in output level.
+20 +20
+10 +10
Width Width
0 0
–10 –10
Output Level (dB)
Output Level (dB)
–20 –20
Threshold Threshold
–30 –30
–40 –40
–50 –50
–60 –60
–70 –70
–70 –60 –50 –40 –30 –20 –10 0 +10 +20 –70 –60 –50 –40 –30 –20 –10 0 +10 +20
Input Level (dB) Input Level (dB)
01V—Owner’s Manual
172 Chapter 13—Dynamics Processors
Parameter Range
THRESHOLD –54 dB to 0 dB (55 steps)
OUT GAIN –18 dB to 0 dB (0.5 dB steps)
WIDTH 1 dB–90 dB (1 dB steps)
ATTACK 0–120 ms (1 ms steps)
5 ms–42.3 s (fs = 48 kHz)
RELEASE
6 ms–46 s (fs = 44.1 kHz)
1:1, 1.1:1, 1.3:1, 1.5:1, 1.7:1, 2:1, 2.5:1, 3:1, 3.5:1, 4:1, 5:1, 6:1, 8:1,
RATIO
10:1, 20:1 (15 steps)
THRESHOLD—This determines the input signal level at which compression and
expansion are applied. Signals at a level below the sum of the threshold and width are
attenuated by the expander. Signals at and above the threshold level are compressed by
the amount specified using the Ratio parameter. The trigger signal is sourced using the
KEY IN parameter.
OUT GAIN—This sets the compander’s output signal level. It can be used to compen-
sate for the overall level change caused by the compression and expansion processes.
WIDTH—This determines how far below the threshold level expansion is applied. The
expander is essentially turned off when the width is set to 90 dB.
ATTACK—This determines how soon the signal is compressed and expanded once the
compander has been triggered. With a fast attack time, the signal is companded almost
immediately. With a slow attack time, however, the initial transient of a sound passes
through unaffected. Attack times from 1 to 5 milliseconds are a good place to start.
RELEASE—This determines how soon the compressor and expander return to their
normal gains once the trigger signal level drops below the threshold. If the release time
is too short, the gain will recover too quickly causing level pumping (i.e., noticeable
gain fluctuations). If it is set too long, the compressor may not have time to recover
before the next high level signal appears, and it will be compressed incorrectly. Release
times from 0.1 to 0.5 seconds are a good place to start.
RATIO—This determines the amount of compression. That is, the change in output
signal level relative to change in input signal level. For a 2:1 ratio, for example, a 10 dB
change in input level (above the threshold) results in a 5 dB change in output level. For
a 5:1 ratio, a 10 dB change in input level (above the threshold) results in a 2 dB change
in output level. The expander ratios are fixed: 1.5:1 for the soft compander (S) and 5:1
for the hard compander (H).
01V—Owner’s Manual
Dynamics Library 173
Dynamics Library
Dynamics settings are stored as programs in the dynamics library, which contains 40
preset programs (1–40) and 40 user programs (41–80). User programs are used to store
custom dynamics settings, which can be titled for easy identification. The dynamics
library can also be used to transfer settings from one dynamics processor to another.
For example, the stereo out dynamics settings could be stored as a library program, and
then recalled to an aux send dynamics processor. The unique collection of preset
dynamics programs is designed for specific applications and instruments, and provides
a good reference and starting point when using the dynamics processors. See page 177
for a complete list of the preset dynamics programs.
The dynamics library is controlled from the library page shown below. Use the
[DYNAMICS] button to locate it.
The top half of the library page contains the STORE, RECALL, and TITLE EDIT
switches. Below these is the library window, which can be scrolled using the PARAME-
TER wheel. The “R” icon next to a preset program means read only. As each program
is selected, its dynamics curve is displayed. The GR meter indicates the amount of gain
reduction being applied to the selected channel. Next to this are level meters for the
selected channel and its neighbor.
01V—Owner’s Manual
174 Chapter 13—Dynamics Processors
01V—Owner’s Manual
Recalling Dynamics Programs 175
01V—Owner’s Manual
176 Chapter 13—Dynamics Processors
01V—Owner’s Manual
Preset Dynamics Program Settings 177
01V—Owner’s Manual
178 Chapter 13—Dynamics Processors
01V—Owner’s Manual
Preset Dynamics Program Settings 179
01V—Owner’s Manual
180 Chapter 13—Dynamics Processors
01V—Owner’s Manual
Preset Dynamics Program Settings 181
01V—Owner’s Manual
182 Chapter 13—Dynamics Processors
01V—Owner’s Manual
Scene Memories 183
Scene Memories
14
In this chapter...
01V—Owner’s Manual
184 Chapter 14—Scene Memories
The area to the left of the page contains the TITLE EDIT, RECALL, and STORE
switches. Next to these is the scene memory list, which can be scrolled using the
PARAMETER wheel. If the INC/DEC MEMORY RECALL option is turned on in the
preferences (“Setting 01V Preferences” on page 203), the [–1/DEC] and [+1/INC] but-
tons can also be used to select and recall scene memories. Scene memory 00 contains
the initial settings and is a read-only memory, which means it can only be recalled. As
each scene memory is selected, the PROTECT switch indicates whether or not it’s pro-
tected. Below this is the RECALL UNDO switch for undoing mix scene recalls. After
intializing the 01V, the RECALL UNDO switch appears gray until a mix scene is
recalled, because there is no data for undoing.
01V—Owner’s Manual
About the Edit Buffer & Indicator 185
Scene memory 02 has just been The EDIT indicator means that a
recalled, so the contents of the Edit parameter has been changed since
Buffer match those of scene memory scene memory 02 was recalled, so the
02. contents of the Edit Buffer no longer
match those of scene memory 02.
The Edit Buffer settings are stored when the 01V is turned off, so they don’t have to be
stored to a scene memory before the 01V is turned off.
Scene Memory 00
Scene memory 00 is a little different to scene memories 1 through 99 in that it’s a
read-only memory and contains the initial 01V settings. You can recall it, but you can-
not store it. To reset all mix settings to their initial values, recall scene memory 00.
01V—Owner’s Manual
186 Chapter 14—Scene Memories
01V—Owner’s Manual
Recalling Mix Scenes 187
01V—Owner’s Manual
188 Chapter 14—Scene Memories
01V—Owner’s Manual
Undoing Mix Scene Recalls 189
01V—Owner’s Manual
190 Chapter 14—Scene Memories
2. Use the cursor buttons to select the list on the left, and the PARAMETER
wheel or [–1/DEC] and [+1/INC] buttons to select a scene memory.
3. Use the cursor buttons to select the list on the right, and the PARAMETER
wheel or [–1/DEC] and [+1/INC] buttons to select the insertion point.
4. Use the cursor buttons to select the SORT switch, and then press the
[ENTER] button.
The selected scene memory is renumbered.
01V—Owner’s Manual
Setting a Fade Time 191
2. Use the cursor buttons to select the TIME control, and the PARAMETER
wheel or [–1/DEC] and [+1/INC] buttons to set it.
The Fade Time can be set from 0 to 25 seconds in 0.1 second steps.
3. Use the cursor buttons to select the FADE ENABLE switches, and the
[ENTER] button to enable channels for fading.
FADE ENABLE switches appear highlighted when channels are enabled for fading.
4. Store the current mix scene in a scene memory. See “Storing Mix Scenes”
on page 186 for more information.
Note: The Fade Time settings must be stored with a mix scene before they have any effect.
5. Recall the mix scene. See “Recalling Mix Scenes” on page 187 for more
information.
When the mix scene is recalled, enabled faders move to their new positions over the
specified time. With a 5-second fade time, for example, it takes the enabled faders 5 sec-
onds to reach their new positions. In a typical crossfade, one channel would fade out
while another channel fades in.
01V—Owner’s Manual
192 Chapter 14—Scene Memories
2. Use the cursor buttons to select the SAFE CHANNEL switches, and the
[ENTER] button to set channels as safe.
SAFE CHANNEL switches appear highlighted for safe channels.
3. Use the cursor buttons to select a MODE (ALL PARAM or FADER ONLY),
and the [ENTER] button to activate it.
In ALL PARAM mode, all parameters are safe. In FADER ONLY mode, only the faders
are safe. All other parameters are updated when mix scenes are recalled.
4. Make sure the SAFE switch is set to ENABLE.
5. Use the cursor buttons to select the SAFE switch, and then press the
[ENTER] button to enable the Recall Safe function.
The SAFE switch works as a master Recall Safe on/off, so you don’t have to set individ-
ual channels when you want a scene recall to update all channels.
6. Recall a mix scene. See “Recalling Mix Scenes” on page 187 for more
information.
When a mix scene is recalled, and providing that the SAFE switch is set to ENABLE, mix
settings on safe channels remain the same.
If a mix scene containing paired channels, fader group, or mute group settings is
recalled, and one of the channels in the pair or group is set as a safe channel, the pair or
group is cancelled and only the non-safe channel is updated.
Recall Safe settings are not stored in mix scenes. They are, however, stored as part of the
01V Setup data. See “Bulk Dump” on page 232 for more information.
01V—Owner’s Manual
Other Functions 193
Other Functions
15
In this chapter...
01V—Owner’s Manual
194 Chapter 15—Other Functions
While this page is displayed, faders and [ON] buttons perform the functions assigned
to them here, not their regular functions.
2. Use [SEL] buttons 1 through 16 and MASTER to select the channels whose
[ON] buttons and faders you want to reassign.
3. Use the cursor buttons to select the parameters boxes, and the PARAM-
ETER wheel or [–1/DEC] and [+1/INC] buttons to set them.
Available functions for the faders and [ON] buttons are listed in the subsequent tables.
4. Use the cursor buttons to select the BANK switches, and then press the
[ENTER] button to activate the selected bank.
The switch of the active bank appears highlighted.
Custom assignments are stored in their respective banks when other banks are selected,
and banks can be stored using MIDI Bulk Dump. See “Bulk Dump” on page 232 for
more information.
To reset a bank back to its initial assignments, make it the active bank, select the INI-
TIALIZE switch, and then press the [ENTER] button. A confirmation dialog box
appears. Select OK, and then press the [ENTER] button to confirm your action. The
selected bank is reset to its initial assignments.
01V—Owner’s Manual
Assigning Faders & On Buttons 195
Fader Assignments
Faders 1 through 16 and master can be assigned to the following parameters.
Parameter Channel
NO ASSIGN — —
CH1–12, CH13-14, CH15-16, CH17–24,
CHANNEL
RETURN1, RETURN2
MASTER AUX1–4, BUS1–4, EFFECT1, EFFECT2, ST OUT
CH1–12, CH13-14, CH15-16, CH17–24,
AUX1 SEND, AUX2 SEND
RETURN1, RETURN2
FADER CH1–12, CH13-14, CH15-16, RETURN1,
AUX3 SEND, AUX4 SEND
RETURN2
CH1–12, CH13-14, CH15-16, CH17–24,
EFF1 SEND
RETURN2
CH1–12, CH13-14, CH15-16, CH17–24,
EFF2 SEND
RETURN1
TIME
CH1–12, CH13-14, CH15-16, ST OUT L, ST
DELAY MIX
OUT R, OMNI1–4
FB GAIN
F LOW
CH1–12, CH13-14, CH15-16, CH17–24,
G LOW
RETURN1, RETURN2, AUX1–4, ST OUT
Q LOW
F L-MID
CH1–12, CH13-14, CH15-16, RETURN1,
G L-MID
RETURN2, AUX1–4, ST OUT
Q L-MID
EQ (F, G, Q) F H-MID
CH1–12, CH13-14, CH15-16, RETURN1,
G H-MID
RETURN2, AUX1–4, ST OUT
Q H-MID
F HIGH
CH1–12, CH13-14, CH15-16, CH17–24,
G HIGH
RETURN1, RETURN2, AUX1–4, ST OUT
Q HIGH
ATT CH1–12, CH13-14, CH15-16, CH17–24
RATIO
KNEE/HOLD
THRESHOLD
DYNAMICS CH1–12, CH13-14, CH15-16, AUX1–4, ST OUT
ATTACK
G/RANGE
REL/DECAY
EFFECT1
EFFECT PARAM1–19
EFFECT2
CHANNEL CH1–24, RETURN1 L, RETURN1 R, RETURN2 L,
AUX1, 2 RETURN2 R
CH1–16, RETURN1 L, RETURN1 R, RETURN2 L,
PAN AUX3, 4
RETURN2 R
BUS TO ST BUS1–4
BALANCE ST OUT
01V—Owner’s Manual
196 Chapter 15—Other Functions
On Button Assignments
On buttons 1 through 16 and master can be assigned to the following parameters.
Parameter Channel
NO ASSIGN — —
CH1–12, CH13-14, CH15-16,
CHANNEL
CH17–24, RETURN1, RETURN2
ON (channel on/off) AUX1–4, BUS1–4, EFFECT1, EFFECT2,
MASTER
ST OUT
BUS TO ST BUS1–4
PHASE
CHANNEL CH1–16
(normal/reverse)
CH1–12, CH13-14, CH15-16,
AUX1 SEND, AUX2 SEND
CH17–24, RETURN1, RETURN2
CH1–12, CH13-14, CH15-16,
AUX3 SEND, AUX4 SEND
RETURN1, RETURN2
PRE/POST (pre/post)
CH1–12, CH13-14, CH15-16,
EFF1 SEND
CH17–24, RETURN2
CH1–12, CH13-14, CH15-16,
EFF2 SEND
CH17–24, RETURN1
CHANNEL CH1–12, CH13-14, CH15-16
DELAY (on/off)
OUTPUT ST OUT L, ST OUT R, OMNI1–4
CH1–12, CH13-14, CH15-16,
CHANNEL
EQ (on/off) CH17–24, RETURN1, RETURN2
OUTPUT AUX1–4, ST OUT
CHANNEL CH1–12, CH13-14, CH15-16
DYNAMICS (on/off)
OUTPUT AUX1–4, ST OUT
01V—Owner’s Manual
Assigning Faders & On Buttons 197
01V—Owner’s Manual
198 Chapter 15—Other Functions
01V—Owner’s Manual
Assigning Faders & On Buttons 199
01V—Owner’s Manual
200 Chapter 15—Other Functions
01V—Owner’s Manual
Assigning Faders & On Buttons 201
01V—Owner’s Manual
202 Chapter 15—Other Functions
2. Use the cursor buttons to select the parameters, and the [ENTER] button,
PARAMETER wheel, or [–1/DEC] and [+1/INC] buttons to set them.
ON/OFF—This switch is used to turn the oscillator on or off.
Note: To prevent sudden tone-burst surprises in your monitors or headphones, set the
oscillator level, stereo output, aux sends, bus outs, or effects returns to a minimal level.
WAVEFORM—This switch is used to select the type of waveform generated by the
oscillator: 100 Hz, 1 kHz, or 10 kHz sine wave tones, pink noise, or burst pink noise,
which consists of 200 ms pulses at four second intervals.
LEVEL—This control is used to adjust the output level of the oscillator from 0 dB to
–96 dB.
ASSIGN—These switches are used to assign the oscillator to individual aux sends, bus
outs, effects sends, or the stereo output.
The Oscillator page also features level meters for the aux sends, bus outs, and effects
returns.
When the oscillator is assigned to a bus, the oscillator signal has priority and other sig-
nals routed to that bus are muted.
01V—Owner’s Manual
Setting 01V Preferences 203
2. Use the cursor buttons to select the parameters, and the [ENTER] button,
PARAMETER wheel, or [–1/DEC] and [+1/INC] buttons to set them.
EQ AUTO SCREEN—When this option is turned on, EQ page 1 or OPTION page 2
appears when the selected channel F or G control is adjusted, or the selected channel
[HIGH], [HI-MID], [LO-MID], or [LOW] button is pressed. See “Adjusting the EQ”
on page 63 for more information.
PANPOT AUTO SCREEN—When this option is turned on, PAN/ROUT page 1 or
OPTION page 2 appears when the selected channel PAN control is adjusted. See “Pan-
ning Input Channels” on page 47 for more information.
STORE CONFIRMATION—When this option is turned on, the Title Edit dialog box,
which also functions as a confirmation, appears whenever a mix scene or library pro-
gram is stored; useful for preventing mix scenes and library programs from being
stored accidentally.
RECALL CONFIRMATION—When this option is turned on, a confirmation dialog
box appears whenever a mix scene or library program is recalled; useful for preventing
mix scenes and library programs from being recalled accidentally.
DIGITAL IN SYNC CAUTION—When this option is turned on, a warning message
appears if digital signals from the Digital Stereo Coaxial In or Option I/O inputs are not
wordclock synchronized with the 01V. See “Setting the Wordclock” on page 209 for
more information.
“SELECTED CH” MESSAGE—When this option is turned on, a message indicating
the selected channel appears when the Fader mode is switched to and from Option I/O.
DELAY UNITS—Delay values for the input channel delay, stereo output delay, and
omni out delay can be specified in milliseconds, meters, or samples. See “Delaying
Channel Signals” on page 45, “Stereo Output Delay” on page 91, and “Omni Out
Delay” on page 117.
INC/DEC SCENE RECALL—When this option is turned on, the [–1/DEC] and
[+1/INC] buttons can be used to select and recall scene memories while MEMORY
page 1 is displayed. As the [–1/DEC] or [+1/INC] button is pressed, subsequent scene
memories that contain a mix scene are selected and recalled. See “Recalling Mix Scenes”
on page 187 for more information.
01V—Owner’s Manual
204 Chapter 15—Other Functions
LIBRARY LIST ORDER—When this option is set to UP, EQ, effects, dynamics, and
scene memory lists appear with the lowest program/scene at the bottom and the highest
at the top. When set to DOWN, they appear with the lowest at the top, highest at the
bottom.
Initial Settings
Preference Options Initial Setting
EQ AUTO SCREEN ON/OFF ON
PANPOT AUTO SCREEN ON/OFF ON
STORE CONFIRMATION ON/OFF ON
RECALL CONFIRMATION ON/OFF OFF
DIGITAL IN SYNC CAUTION ON/OFF ON
“SELECTED CH” MESSAGE ON/OFF ON
DELAY UNITS msec, meter, sample msec
INC/DEC SCENE RECALL ON/OFF OFF
LIBRARY LIST ORDER UP/DOWN UP
01V—Owner’s Manual
Using the Digital Inputs & Outputs 205
16
In this chapter...
01V—Owner’s Manual
206 Chapter 16—Using the Digital Inputs & Outputs
About Wordclocks
Unlike analog audio equipment, digital audio equipment must be synchronized when
digital audio is transferred from one device to another. Otherwise, the digital audio
might not be read correctly and audible noise, glitches, or clicks may occur. Synchroni-
zation is achieved using what’s called a wordclock, which is a clock signal for synchro-
nizing all the digital audio words in an audio system. Note that wordclocks are not the
same as SMPTE or MIDI timecode, which are used to synchronize audio recorders,
MIDI sequencers, and so on. Wordclock synchronization refers to the synchronization
of the digital audio processing circuits inside each digital audio device.
In a typical digital audio system, one device acts as the wordclock master and the other
devices act as wordclock slaves that synchronize to the master wordclock signal. If the
01V is the only digital audio device in your system, no special wordclock settings are
required and the 01V synchronizes to its own internal wordclock. Add a DAT recorder
or digital multitrack recorder, however, and you must decide which device to use as
wordclock master and which devices to use as slaves. Even when you’ve done this and
configured your system, it may be necessary to change the wordclock settings in certain
situations, such as when recording from a DAT or CD player.
The wordclock signal runs at the same frequency as the sampling rate. The 01V gener-
ates its own wordclock at 44.1 kHz (the industry-standard sampling rate for music
CDs) and can be used as wordclock master. Alternatively, it can be used as a wordclock
slave synchronized to an external wordclock of between 44.1 kHz –10% and 48 kHz
+6%. Converting the sampling rate of digital audio is a complicated process, so it’s best
to use the 44.1 kHz sampling rate, especially if your work is destined for CD distribu-
tion.
Wordclock signals can be distributed via dedicated cables or derived from standard dig-
ital audio connections, as shown below. With AES/EBU and Coaxial digital audio con-
nections, a wordclock signal is transmitted even when no audio signal is present.
In a system where all devices share a common wordclock, it’s important that all devices
be turned on even when they’re not being used. Turn on the wordclock master first, and
then the slaves. When shutting down the system, turn off the slaves first, and then the
master. Before commencing with a recording session, make sure that all wordclock
slaves are synchronized to the master wordclock. Some devices have front panel indica-
tors to show when they are wordclock synchronized. Refer to the instructions for each
device.
The following system examples show three typical wordclock setups with the 01V. For
detailed system examples with specific equipment, see “System Examples” on page 241.
01V—Owner’s Manual
About Wordclocks 207
INPUT (BAL)
–10dBV (UNBAL)
13 15 L
R
14 16
IN OUT
2TR
PHONES
PAD
26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 15/16 MONITOR
2TR IN 2TR IN
–16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 +10 –20 +10 –20 0 10 0 10
+10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 GAIN GAIN LEVEL LEVEL
MONITOR
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13/14 15/16 OUT PHONES
EQ HIGH L STEREO R
PAN CLIP
UTILITY MIDI SETUP VIEW –3
–6
PAN HI-MID
FUNCTION –9
–12
PAN/ F F –15
DYNAMICS EQ/ATT Ø/DELAY ROUTING MEMORY –18
G LO-MID –24
–30
–36
FADER MODE –42
EFFECT 1 EFFECT 2 OPTION I/O REMOTE G LOW –48
1 RETURN 2
SELECTED CHANNEL
AUX 1 AUX 2 AUX 3 AUX 4
HOME
ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON MEMORY
–1/DEC
PARAMETER
+1/INC
DIGITAL STEREO
6
5
6
5
6
5
6
5
6
5
6
5
6
5
6
5
6
5
6
5
6
5
6
5
6
5
6
5
0
–5
–10
–15
–20
COAXIAL OUT
00.00.00.00
DAT
CURSOR
10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10
–30
20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 –40
–50
Digital In
40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40
60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 –70
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
– ∞
ENTER
In this system, the 01V’s stereo output signal is digitally transferred to a DAT recorder.
The 01V works as wordclock master and the DAT works as wordclock slave. The 01V is
set to internal wordclock. The DAT derives its wordclock signal from the Digital Stereo
Coaxial Out connection of the 01V. Both devices operate at a sampling rate of 44.1 kHz.
Multitrack Recording
01V (wordclock slave) Digital multitrack
PHANTOM +48V OFF ON
INPUT (BAL)
PHANTOM +48V OFF ON
13 15 L
–10dBV (UNBAL)
(wordclock master)
14 16
R
IN OUT
Digital In
2TR
PHONES
PAD
26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 15/16 MONITOR
2TR IN 2TR IN
–16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 +10 –20 +10 –20 0 10 0 10
OPTION I/O
+10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 GAIN GAIN LEVEL LEVEL
MONITOR
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13/14 15/16 OUT PHONES
HI-MID
L STEREO R
CLIP
–3
–6
–9
8-TRACK DIGITAL
FUNCTION
Digital Out
–12
PAN/ F F –15
DYNAMICS EQ/ATT Ø/DELAY ROUTING MEMORY –18
G LO-MID –24
–30
–36
FADER MODE –42
EFFECT 1 EFFECT 2 OPTION I/O REMOTE G LOW –48
1 RETURN 2
SELECTED CHANNEL
AUX 1 AUX 2 AUX 3 AUX 4
HOME
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON MEMORY
DAT (wordclock slave)
–1/DEC +1/INC DIGITAL STEREO
DAT
PARAMETER
00.00.00.00
6
5
6
5
6
5
6
5
6
5
6
5
6
5
6
5
6
5
6
5
6
5
6
5
6
5
6
5
0
–5
–10
–15
COAXIAL OUT
–20
CURSOR
10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10
–30
20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 –40
–50
Digital In
40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40
60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 –70
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
– ∞
ENTER
In this system, audio is recorded to, and mixed from the digital multitrack recorder. The
01V’s stereo output signal is digitally transferred to the DAT recorder. The digital mul-
titrack recorder is wordclock master and the 01V and DAT recorder are wordclock
slaves. The 01V derives its wordclock from the Option I/O digital input. The DAT
derives its wordclock signal from the Digital Stereo Coaxial Out connection of the 01V.
The sampling rate is the same as that used when the digital multitrack tapes were for-
matted or recorded.
01V—Owner’s Manual
208 Chapter 16—Using the Digital Inputs & Outputs
INPUT (BAL)
PHANTOM +48V OFF ON
13 15 L
–10dBV (UNBAL)
(wordclock slave)
14 16
R
IN OUT
Digital In
2TR
PHONES
PAD
26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 15/16 MONITOR
2TR IN 2TR IN
–16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 +10 –20 +10 –20 0 10 0 10
OPTION I/O
+10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 GAIN GAIN LEVEL LEVEL
MONITOR
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13/14 15/16 OUT PHONES
HI-MID
L STEREO R
CLIP
–3
–6
–9
8-TRACK DIGITAL
FUNCTION
Digital Out
–12
PAN/ F F –15
DYNAMICS EQ/ATT Ø/DELAY ROUTING MEMORY –18
G LO-MID –24
–30
–36
FADER MODE –42
SELECTED CHANNEL
AUX 1 AUX 2 AUX 3 AUX 4
HOME
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON MEMORY
DAT (wordclock master)
–1/DEC +1/INC DIGITAL STEREO
DAT
PARAMETER
00.00.00.00
6
5
6
5
6
5
6
5
6
5
6
5
6
5
6
5
6
5
6
5
6
5
6
5
6
5
6
5
0
–5
–10
–15
COAXIAL IN
–20
CURSOR
10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10
–30
20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 –40
Digital Out
–50
40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40
60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 –70
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
– ∞
ENTER
In this system, audio is recorded to, and mixed from the digital multitrack recorder.
The DAT output signal is digitally transferred to the 01V for recording to the digital
multitrack recorder. The DAT recorder is wordclock master and the 01V and digital
multitrack recorder are wordclock slaves. The 01V derives its wordclock from the
Digital Stereo Coaxial In connection. The digital multitrack recorder derives its
wordclock from the 01V’s Option I/O connection. The sampling rate is the same as
that used when the DAT tape was recorded. A CD player could be connected instead of
the DAT recorder. In this case, the sampling rate would be fixed at 44.1 kHz, the
industry-standard sampling rate for music CDs.
01V—Owner’s Manual
Setting the Wordclock 209
Note: When the wordclock source is changed, audible glitches or clicks may be produced,
so it’s a good idea to turn down the volume on all monitor amps and headphones first.
2. Use the cursor buttons to select the SOURCE switches, and the [ENTER]
button to set them.
AUTO NAVIGATE—This function checks all possible wordclock sources and then dis-
plays a dialog box recommending a suitable source. Note that in some situations this
function may not be able to recommend a suitable source. The following dialog box
appears when this function is run. Select OK, and press the [ENTER] button to start
digital input scanning.
This switch selects the Digital Stereo In as the wordclock source. A switch like
the one shown here with a single diagonal line indicates that a wordclock sig-
nal is present at this input but the 01V is not synchronized to it.
This switch selects the Option I/O card as the wordclock source. A switch like
the one shown here with two diagonal lines indicates that no wordclock signal
is present at this input.
01V—Owner’s Manual
210 Chapter 16—Using the Digital Inputs & Outputs
A highlighted switch with two diagonal lines like the one shown here indicates
that no wordclock is being received from the selected source, and the Fs win-
dow will probably show UNLOCK. Before using the 01V, correct the external
wordclock, or select another source. This condition typically occurs when the
external wordclock source is turned off, or the cable carrying the wordclock
signal has been disconnected.
If the DIGITAL IN SYNC CAUTION option is turned on in the preferences (“Setting
01V Preferences” on page 203), a warning message appears if digital signals from the
Digital Stereo Coaxial In or Option I/O inputs are not wordclock synchronized with the
01V. If this message appears, configure the external device as wordclock master.
When an MY8-AE Option I/O card is installed, the OPTION SLOT switch is replaced
by four SLOT switches, as shown below.
These switches are used to select a pair of AES/EBU digital inputs as the wordclock
source.
This window displays the status of the 01V wordclock. 44.1k indicates
that the 01V is locked to a sampling rate of 44.1 kHz. When the word-
clock source is changed, the word LOCK appears, indicating that the 01V
is in the process of locking to the new source. If the external wordclock
source is lost, the word UNLOCK appears. This condition typically
occurs when the external wordclock source is turned off or the cable car-
rying the wordclock signal has been disconnected.
When a CD player is connected to the Digital Stereo In, the only available sampling rate
is 44.1 kHz. When a DAT is connected, the sampling rate is determined by the DAT.
Some DATs record at a fixed sampling rate, while others allow the user to choose, typi-
cally between 44.1 kHz and 48 kHz.
01V—Owner’s Manual
Digital Stereo Out 211
01V
PHANTOM +48V OFF ON PHANTOM +48V OFF ON
INPUT (BAL)
–10dBV (UNBAL)
13 15 L
R
14 16
IN OUT
2TR
PHONES
PAD
26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 15/16 MONITOR
2TR IN 2TR IN
–16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 +10 –20 +10 –20 0 10 0 10
+10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 GAIN GAIN LEVEL LEVEL
MONITOR
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13/14 15/16 OUT PHONES
EQ HIGH L STEREO R
PAN CLIP
UTILITY MIDI SETUP VIEW –3
–6
PAN HI-MID
FUNCTION –9
–12
PAN/ F F –15
DYNAMICS EQ/ATT Ø/DELAY ROUTING MEMORY –18
G LO-MID –24
–30
–36
FADER MODE –42
SELECTED CHANNEL
AUX 1 AUX 2 AUX 3 AUX 4
HOME
DAT recorder
SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO
ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON MEMORY
–1/DEC
PARAMETER
+1/INC
DIGITAL STEREO
6
5
6
5
6
5
6
5
6
5
6
5
6
5
6
5
6
5
6
5
6
5
6
5
6
5
6
5
0
–5
–10
–15
–20
COAXIAL OUT
00.00.00.00
DAT
CURSOR
10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10
–30
20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 –40
–50
Digital In
40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40
60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 –70
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
– ∞
ENTER
01V—Owner’s Manual
212 Chapter 16—Using the Digital Inputs & Outputs
Output Dither
When a high-resolution digital audio signal is transferred to a lower-resolution system,
some of the least-significant bits (LSB) of data are ignored by the receiving system,
which can make low-level signals sound grainy and step like, similar to the noise pro-
duced by a low-resolution digital reverb as signals fade. To prevent this, the wordlength
of a digital audio signal can be shortened to match that of the receiving system. Instead
of simply chopping the unwanted bits off, the 01V uses the industry-standard tech-
nique known as dither is used to optimize the wordlength reduction process.
Dither can be set independently for the Digital Stereo Out and Option I/O digital out-
puts, and should be matched to the wordlength supported by the receiving digital audio
device. For example, with a 16-bit DAT recorder connected to the Digital Stereo Out,
the DIGITAL ST OUT should be set to a wordlength of 16, and with a 20-bit digital
multitrack recorder connected via the Option I/O, OPTION OUT should be set to 20.
1. Use the [SETUP] button to locate SETUP page 5, as shown below.
2. Use the cursor buttons to select the WORD LENGTH switches, and the
[ENTER] button to set them.
Dither works by comparing the output of a special pseudorandom number sequence
generator with the lowest data bit of the shortened data word and the unwanted data
bits. The lowest bit is then rounded up or down prior to D/A conversion, thereby opti-
mizing the digital output signal for use with lower-resolution systems. Since dither
endows the digital signal with a noise floor close to the minimum theoretical limit,
some audio professionals choose not to use it for applications with a wide dynamic
range, such as classical recording. If you’re in any doubt, it’s probably best to use it.
01V—Owner’s Manual
Digital Stereo In 213
Digital Stereo In
Consumer format digital audio signals can be connected to the DIGITAL STEREO
01V using the Digital Stereo In Coaxial connection. The digital COAXIAL
output of a CD player, DAT, or MiniDisc deck could be con-
OUT IN
nected here, or the Digital Stereo Out of another 01V for cas-
cade operation. See “Cascading 01Vs” on page 214 for more
information.
1. Use the [PAN/ROUTING] button to locate PAN/ROUT page 4, as shown
below.
2. Use the cursor buttons to select the FLIP and ON/OFF switches, and the
[ENTER] button to set them.
FLIP—This switch is used to flip the inputs of input channels 13 and 14 with the Digital
Stereo In. Normally, analog inputs 13 and 14 feed input channels 13 and 14, and the
Digital Stereo In feeds the Stereo bus. When flipped, analog inputs 13 and 14 feed the
Stereo bus, and the Digital Stereo In feeds input channels 13 and 14.
ON/OFF—This switch is used to turn on or off the stereo cascade signal. The source of
the stereo cascade signal is set by the FLIP switch. The stereo cascade signal can be mon-
itored pre or post this switch using the monitors or phones. See “Monitor Setup” on
page 78 for more information.
Note: To prevent noise when using the Digital Stereo In connection, the source device
and the 01V must be wordclock synchronized. See “About Wordclocks” on page 206 for
more information.
Digital audio signals containing emphasis are automatically deemphasized.
In the following example, the Digital Stereo Coaxial In on the 01V is connected to the
digital output of a DAT recorder for mixing from a digital source. The 01V works as
wordclock slave, while the DAT works as wordclock master. On 01V SETUP page 1, set
the wordclock source to ST IN DIGITAL. See “Setting the Wordclock” on page 209 for
more information.
01V
PHANTOM +48V OFF ON PHANTOM +48V OFF ON
INPUT (BAL)
–10dBV (UNBAL)
13 15 L
R
14 16
IN OUT
2TR
PHONES
PAD
26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 15/16 MONITOR
2TR IN 2TR IN
–16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 +10 –20 +10 –20 0 10 0 10
+10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 GAIN GAIN LEVEL LEVEL
MONITOR
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13/14 15/16 OUT PHONES
EQ HIGH L STEREO R
PAN CLIP
UTILITY MIDI SETUP VIEW –3
–6
PAN HI-MID
FUNCTION –9
–12
PAN/ F F –15
DYNAMICS EQ/ATT Ø/DELAY ROUTING MEMORY –18
G LO-MID –24
–30
–36
FADER MODE –42
SELECTED CHANNEL
AUX 1 AUX 2 AUX 3 AUX 4
HOME
DAT recorder
SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO
ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON MEMORY
–1/DEC
PARAMETER
+1/INC
DIGITAL STEREO
6
5
6
5
6
5
6
5
6
5
6
5
6
5
6
5
6
5
6
5
6
5
6
5
6
5
6
5
0
–5
–10
–15
–20
COAXIAL IN
00.00.00.00
DAT
CURSOR
10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10
–30
20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 –40
–50
Digital Out
40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40
60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 –70
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
– ∞
ENTER
01V—Owner’s Manual
214 Chapter 16—Using the Digital Inputs & Outputs
Cascading 01Vs
By using the Stereo Digital In and Stereo Digital Out connections, two 01Vs can be cas-
caded together for 48-channel digital mixing, as shown below. 01V-A audio signals are
combined into a stereo mix that is then sent to 01V-B via the Digital Stereo Coaxial
connections and mixed with the audio signals of 01V-B. 01V-A works as wordclock
master and is set to INT 44.1K, while 01V-B works as wordclock slave with its word-
clock source set to ST IN DIGITAL. See “Setting the Wordclock” on page 209 for more
information.
01V-A (sub-mixer) 01V-B (main-mixer)
PHANTOM +48V OFF ON PHANTOM +48V OFF ON PHANTOM +48V OFF ON PHANTOM +48V OFF ON
R R
DIGITAL STEREO
14 16 14 16
IN OUT IN OUT
2TR 2TR
PHONES PHONES
PAD PAD
COAXIAL OUT
26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 15/16 MONITOR 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 15/16 MONITOR
2TR IN 2TR IN 2TR IN 2TR IN
–16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 +10 –20 +10 –20 0 10 0 10 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 +10 –20 +10 –20 0 10 0 10
+10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 GAIN GAIN LEVEL LEVEL +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 GAIN GAIN LEVEL LEVEL
MONITOR MONITOR
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13/14 15/16 OUT PHONES 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13/14 15/16 OUT PHONES
EQ HIGH L STEREO R
DIGITAL STEREO DIGITAL MIXING CONSOLE
EQ HIGH L STEREO R
PAN CLIP PAN CLIP
COAXIAL IN
UTILITY MIDI SETUP VIEW –3 UTILITY MIDI SETUP VIEW –3
–6 –6
PAN HI-MID PAN HI-MID
FUNCTION –9 FUNCTION –9
–12 –12
PAN/ F F –15 PAN/ F F –15
DYNAMICS EQ/ATT Ø/DELAY ROUTING MEMORY –18 DYNAMICS EQ/ATT Ø/DELAY ROUTING MEMORY –18
G LO-MID –24 G LO-MID –24
–30 –30
–36 –36
FADER MODE –42 FADER MODE –42
HOME HOME
SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO
ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON MEMORY ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON MEMORY
6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 0 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 0
–5 –5
0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 –10 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 –10
–15 –15
5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5
–20 –20
CURSOR CURSOR
10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10
–30 –30
20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 –40 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 –40
–50 –50
40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40
60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 –70 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 –70
∞ ∞ ∞ ∞ ∞ ∞ ∞ ∞ ∞ ∞ ∞ ∞ ∞ ∞ –∞ ∞ ∞ ∞ ∞ ∞ ∞ ∞ ∞ ∞ ∞ ∞ ∞ ∞ ∞ –∞
ENTER ENTER
For cascade operation, 01V-B Coaxial input should not be flipped and Stereo Cascade
should be turned on. See “Digital Stereo In” on page 213 for more information.
Link Port
For simultaneous solo operation, display page and fader mode selection, two or more
01Vs can be linked together using the TO HOST or MIDI ports. See “Linking 01Vs” on
page 239.
01V—Owner’s Manual
Cascading 01Vs 215
Cascade Delay
Since it takes 01V-A several hundred microseconds to process its digital audio data, the
input signals of 01V-B need to be delayed slightly to bring them into phase with the sig-
nals from 01V-A. The following illustration shows why phase correction is necessary.
L R L R
Since signal L has been processed by
STEREO STEREO both 01V-A and 01V-B, it's out of
DIGITAL DIGITAL phase with signal R. To bring the
OUT IN signals back in phase, input signal R
is delayed by 14 samples on 01V-B.
01V-A 01V-B
This kind of phase correction is not unique to the 01V. All digital audio equipment
takes a few hundred microseconds to process digital audio data. Use the Delay function
(“Delaying Channel Signals” on page 45) on 01V-B to delay all input channels by 14
samples.
DIGITAL DIGITAL
STEREO STEREO
COAXIAL COAXIAL
01V-A OUT
01V-B 01V-C
IN OUT IN
01V—Owner’s Manual
216 Chapter 16—Using the Digital Inputs & Outputs
01V—Owner’s Manual
About Option I/O Cards 217
Card Specifications
Card Description Inputs Outputs Connector
MY8-AT ADAT Digital I/O 8 (CH17–24) Optical x2
MY8-TD Tascam TDIF-1 Digital I/O 8 (CH17–24) 8 (bus, aux, ste- 25-pin D-sub x1
reo, ch direct)
MY8-AE*1 AES/EBU Digital I/O 8 (CH17–24) 25-pin D-sub x1
4 (bus, aux, ste- XLR-3-32 type
MY4-DA Analog output —
reo, ch direct) (balanced) x4
MY8-AD Analog input 8 (CH17–24) — Phone jack x8
XLR-3-31 type
MY4-AD Analog input 4 (CH17–20) —
(balanced) x4
*1. Cable not included.
The eight Option I/O digital inputs feed input channels 17 through 24. See “Input
Channels 17–24” on page 40 for more information. The inputs to channels 1 through
8 can be swapped with those of input channels 17 through 24 either individually or
altogether. This allows signals from the Option I/O digital inputs to make use of the
4-band EQ, dynamics processors, and other functions of full-feature input channels 1
through 8. See “Swapping Inputs 1–8 & 17–24” on page 51 for more information.
Option I/O digital audio signals containing emphasis are automatically deemphasized.
The eight Option I/O digital outputs can be assigned to bus outs 1 through 4, aux sends
1 through 4, the left or right channels of the stereo output, or the post-fader direct out-
puts of input channels 1 through 16. See “Assigning Option I/O Digital Outputs” on
page 219 for more information.
01V—Owner’s Manual
218 Chapter 16—Using the Digital Inputs & Outputs
4. Secure the card using the two fixing screws. Do not leave the screws
loose, as the card will not be grounded correctly.
5. Turn on the 01V.
The 01V checks to see what type of Option I/O card is installed when it’s turned on. If
installation is successful, the type of card installed is displayed on OPTION page 1, as
shown below.
01V—Owner’s Manual
Assigning Option I/O Digital Outputs 219
2. Use the cursor buttons to select the switches, and the [ENTER] button,
PARAMETER wheel, or [–1/DEC] and [+1/INC] buttons to set them.
Switches appear highlighted when selected as the output source.
Option I/O digital outputs are automatically assigned to post-fader direct outputs of
input channels 1 through 12 when the corresponding D switch on PAN/ROUT page 1
is turned on. Likewise, when a direct output is selected as the source for an Option I/O
output on this page, the corresponding D switch is turned on on the PAN/ROUT page.
See “Routing Input Channels” on page 49 for more information.
01V—Owner’s Manual
220
01V—Owner’s Manual
BUS AUX EFF ST
1 2 3 4 1 2 3 4 1 2 L R
Meter
INPUT Meter
1-8 Unchanged STEREO L
(BAL) Unchanged
STEREO R
BUS 1
SWAP Meter
Meter BUS 4
CH Fader PAN AUX 1 Option I/O
Option I/O De-emphasis
17-24 IN 2-Band Output Option Option I/O
or DC Cut from 1-8
PEQ Select Meter I/O OUT
ON AUX 4 Dither
ATT AUX1
CH 1
Chapter 16—Using the Digital Inputs & Outputs
AUX2 CH 2
Meter
EFF1
CH 15
Option I/O Block Diagram
EFF2 CH 16
This section is available only when
an optional Option I/O card is installed. AUX/EFF
PRE/POST
MIDI 221
MIDI
17
In this chapter...
01V—Owner’s Manual
222 Chapter 17—MIDI
MIDI Ports
The MIDI IN port receives MIDI messages, while the MIDI OUT port transmits them.
The MIDI THRU port transmits all MIDI messages received at the MIDI IN port. In
addition to regular MIDI ports, the 01V features a TO HOST port for connecting to a
personal computer without a MIDI interface.
MIDI TO HOST
THRU OUT IN
Apart from being a bidirectional connection that can transmit and receive MIDI data,
the TO HOST port functions in the same way as the regular MIDI ports. Whether you
use the regular MIDI ports or TO HOST port will depend on your particular system
and application. The PORT parameter on MIDI page 1 is used to select the port for reg-
ular MIDI transmission. See “MIDI Setup” on page 224 for more information. The
unused port automatically becomes the LINK PORT, which is used for simultaneous
operation with another 01V.
01V—Owner’s Manual
MIDI Ports 223
01V
PHANTOM +48V OFF ON PHANTOM +48V OFF ON
INPUT (BAL)
–10dBV (UNBAL)
13 15 L
R
14 16
MIDI Sequencer
IN OUT
2TR
PHONES
PAD
26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 15/16 MONITOR
2TR IN 2TR IN
–16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 +10 –20 +10 –20 0 10 0 10
+10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 GAIN GAIN LEVEL LEVEL
MONITOR
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13/14 15/16 OUT PHONES
EQ HIGH L STEREO R
PAN CLIP
UTILITY MIDI SETUP VIEW –3
–6
PAN HI-MID
FUNCTION –9
–12
PAN/ F F –15
DYNAMICS EQ/ATT Ø/DELAY ROUTING MEMORY –18
G LO-MID –24
–30
–36
FADER MODE –42
EFFECT 1 EFFECT 2 OPTION I/O REMOTE G LOW –48
1 RETURN 2
SELECTED CHANNEL
AUX 1 AUX 2 AUX 3 AUX 4
HOME
SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO
ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON MEMORY
6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 0
–5
0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 –10
–15
5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5
–20
CURSOR
10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10
–30
20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 –40
–50
40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40
60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 –70
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
– ∞
ENTER
01V
PHANTOM +48V OFF ON PHANTOM +48V OFF ON
INPUT (BAL)
–10dBV (UNBAL)
13 15 L
R
14 16
IN OUT
2TR
PHONES
PAD
26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 15/16 MONITOR
2TR IN 2TR IN
Serial port
–16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 +10 –20 +10 –20 0 10 0 10
+10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 GAIN GAIN LEVEL LEVEL
MONITOR
MIDI IN
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13/14 15/16 OUT PHONES
PAN/
FUNCTION
PAN
F F
PAN
EQ HIGH
HI-MID
L STEREO R
CLIP
–3
–6
–9
–12
–15
DYNAMICS EQ/ATT Ø/DELAY ROUTING MEMORY –18
G LO-MID –24
–30
–36
FADER MODE –42
SELECTED CHANNEL
AUX 1 AUX 2 AUX 3 AUX 4
HOME
MIDI keyboard
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON MEMORY
–1/DEC +1/INC
PARAMETER
MIDI IN 6
5
6
5
6
5
6
5
6
5
6
5
6
5
6
5
6
5
6
5
6
5
6
5
6
5
6
5
0
–5
–10
–15
–20
CURSOR
10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10
–30
20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 –40
–50
40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40
60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 –70
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
– ∞
ENTER
MIDI Sampler
MIDI IN
01V—Owner’s Manual
224 Chapter 17—MIDI
INPUT (BAL)
PHANTOM +48V OFF ON
13 15 L
–10dBV (UNBAL) DIGITAL STEREO PHANTOM +48V OFF ON
INPUT (BAL)
PHANTOM +48V OFF ON
13 15 L
–10dBV (UNBAL)
14 16
R
IN
2TR
OUT
PHONES
COAXIAL OUT 14 16
R
IN
2TR
OUT
PHONES
PAD PAD
26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 15/16 MONITOR 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 15/16 MONITOR
2TR IN 2TR IN 2TR IN 2TR IN
–16 –60
+10 GAIN –34
1
–16 –60
+10 GAIN –34
2
–16 –60
+10 GAIN –34
3
–16 –60
+10 GAIN –34
4
–16 –60
+10 GAIN –34
5
–16 –60
+10 GAIN –34
6
–16 –60
+10 GAIN –34
7
–16 –60
+10 GAIN –34
8
–16 –60
+10 GAIN –34
9
–16 –60
+10 GAIN –34
10
–16 –60
+10 GAIN –34
11
–16 –60
+10 GAIN –34
12
+10
13/14
GAIN
–20 +10
15/16
GAIN
–20 0
OUT
LEVEL
MONITOR
10 0
LEVEL
PHONES
10
1
–16 –60
+10 GAIN –34
2
–16 –60
+10 GAIN –34
3
–16 –60
+10 GAIN –34
4
–16 –60
+10 GAIN –34
5
–16 –60
+10 GAIN –34
6
–16 –60
+10 GAIN –34
7
–16 –60
+10 GAIN –34
8
–16 –60
+10 GAIN –34
9
–16 –60
+10 GAIN –34
10
–16 –60
+10 GAIN –34
11
–16 –60
+10 GAIN –34
12
+10
13/14
GAIN
–20 +10
15/16
GAIN
–20 0
LEVEL
MONITOR
OUT
10 0
LEVEL
PHONES
10
L STEREO R
COAXIAL IN DIGITAL MIXING CONSOLE
L STEREO R
EQ HIGH EQ HIGH
PAN CLIP PAN CLIP
UTILITY MIDI SETUP VIEW –3 UTILITY MIDI SETUP VIEW –3
–6 –6
PAN HI-MID PAN HI-MID
FUNCTION –9 FUNCTION –9
–12 –12
PAN/ F F –15 PAN/ F F –15
DYNAMICS EQ/ATT Ø/DELAY ROUTING MEMORY –18 DYNAMICS EQ/ATT Ø/DELAY ROUTING MEMORY –18
G LO-MID –24 G LO-MID –24
–30 –30
–36 –36
TO HOST
FADER MODE –42 FADER MODE –42
TO HOST
EFFECT 1 EFFECT 2 OPTION I/O REMOTE G LOW –48
EFFECT 1 EFFECT 2 OPTION I/O REMOTE G LOW –48
1 RETURN 2 1 RETURN 2
HOME HOME
SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO
ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON
–1/DEC
ON
PARAMETER
MEMORY
+1/INC
OR ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON
–1/DEC
ON
PARAMETER
MEMORY
+1/INC
20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 –40 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 –40
–50 –50
40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40
60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 –70 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 –70
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
– ∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
– ∞
ENTER ENTER
1
17
2
18
3
19
4
20
5
21
6
22
7
23
8
24
9 10 11 12 13/14 15/16 STEREO
MASTER
MIDI IN MIDI OUT 1
17
2
18
3
19
4
20
5
21
6
22
7
23
8
24
9 10 11 12 13/14 15/16 STEREO
MASTER
Note: When the MIDI ports and TO HOST ports of two 01Vs are connected together, be
sure to turn off the Program Change Tx and Rx switches. Otherwise, a MIDI loop will
occur when mix scenes are recalled.
MIDI Setup
MIDI parameters such as transmit channel (Tx), receive channel (Rx), omni, and echo
are set on MIDI page 1.
1. Use the [MIDI] button to locate MIDI page 1, as shown below.
2. Use the cursor buttons to select the parameters, and the [ENTER] button,
PARAMETER wheel, or [–1/DEC] and [+1/INC] buttons to set them.
PORT/LINK PORT—The PORT parameter determines whether the TO HOST or
MIDI ports are used for regular MIDI transmission. The LINK PORT parameter, used
when linking 01Vs (“Linking 01Vs” on page 239), is automatically set to the unused
port. If, for example, PORT is set to MIDI, LINK PORT will be set to HOST, and vice
01V—Owner’s Manual
MIDI Setup 225
versa. When using the TO HOST port, PORT should be set to match the type of com-
puter connected to the 01V, as follows.
Setting Computer Platform Port Transmission Speed
MIDI Standard MIDI MIDI IN, OUT, THRU 31.25 kbps
PC1 NEC PC9800 Series TO HOST 31.25 kbps
PC2 IBM PC compatible TO HOST 38.4 kbps
Mac Macintosh (clock: 1MHz) TO HOST 31.25 kbps
Tx CH—This parameter determines which MIDI Channel the 01V uses to transmit
MIDI messages, and can be set from 1 through 16. The device receiving MIDI messages
from the 01V should be set to the same MIDI Channel. When the 01V transmits MIDI
data in response to a request, that data is transmitted on the same MIDI Channel that
the request was received on.
Rx CH—This parameter determines which MIDI Channel the 01V uses to receive
MIDI messages, and can be set from 1 through 16. The device transmitting MIDI mes-
sages to the 01V should be set to the same MIDI Channel. When PROGRAM CHANGE
OMNI or CONTROL CHANGE OMNI is turned on, program change and Control
Change messages can be received regardless of this setting.
PROGRAM CHANGE—Program Change messages are used to recall mix scenes. See
“Program Change Scene Recall” on page 227 for more information. The four ON/OFF
switches in this group are as follows.
Tx determines whether the 01V transmits Program Change messages when a mix scene
is recalled. Rx determines whether the 01V recalls mix scenes when Program Change
messages are received. OMNI determines whether the 01V receives Program Change
messages on all 16 MIDI Channels (ON) or just the Rx channel (OFF).
ECHO determines whether received Program Change messages are echoed through to
the MIDI OUT port. When ECHO is on, the 01V receives Program Change messages
and echoes them through to the MIDI OUT port regardless of the MIDI Channel set-
tings.
CONTROL CHANGE—Control Change messages are used to control 01V parameters
in real time. See “Control Change Parameter Control” on page 229 for more informa-
tion. The four ON/OFF switches in this group are as follows.
Tx determines whether the 01V transmits Control Change messages when mix param-
eters are adjusted. Rx determines whether the 01V adjusts mix parameters when Con-
trol Change messages are received. OMNI determines whether the 01V receives Control
Change messages on all 16 MIDI Channels (ON) or just the Rx channel (OFF).
ECHO determines whether received Control Change messages are echoed through to
the MIDI OUT port. When ECHO is on, the 01V receives Control Change messages
and echoes them through to the MIDI OUT port regardless of the MIDI Channel set-
tings.
PARAM. CHANGE—Parameter Change System Exclusive messages are used to con-
trol 01V parameters in real time. See “System Exclusive Parameter Control” on page 231
for more information. The three ON/OFF switches in this group are as follows.
Tx determines whether the 01V transmits Parameter Change System Exclusive mes-
sages when mix parameters are adjusted. Rx determines whether or not the 01V adjusts
mix parameters when Parameter Change System Exclusive messages are received.
When Rx is turned on, the 01V transmits Parameter Change System Exclusive messages
in response to requests even if Tx is turned off.
01V—Owner’s Manual
226 Chapter 17—MIDI
ECHO determines whether received Parameter Change System Exclusive messages are
echoed through to the MIDI OUT port. When ECHO is on, the 01V receives Parameter
Change System Exclusive messages and echoes them through to the MIDI OUT port
regardless of the MIDI Channel settings.
BULK—This switch determines whether the 01V receives MIDI Bulk requests and
MIDI Bulk Dump messages. When turned on, the 01V transmits Bulk Dump messages
in response to Bulk Dump requests. Bulk Dump messages and Bulk Dump requests are
never echoed. Bulk Dump messages can be transmitted from the 01V regardless of this
setting. See “Bulk Dump” on page 232 for more information.
01V—Owner’s Manual
Program Change Scene Recall 227
2. Use the cursor buttons to select the PGM CHG. column, and then use the
PARAMETER wheel or [–1/DEC] and [+1/INC] buttons to select a Program
Change.
3. Use the right cursor button to select the NO. TITLE column, and then use
the PARAMETER wheel or [–1/DEC] and [+1/INC] buttons to select a
scene memory.
A scene memory to Program Change assignment table is
provided on page 273. To reset the assignments to their ini-
tial settings, use the cursor buttons to select the INITIAL-
IZE switch, and then press the [ENTER] button. The
dialog box shown here appears. Click OK to initialize.
The current scene memory to Program Change assignment table can be stored to an
external MIDI device, such as a MIDI data filer, using MIDI Bulk Dump. See “Bulk
Dump” on page 232 for more information.
If a scene memory is assigned to two or more Program Changes, the lowest Program
Change is transmitted when that scene memory is recalled.
If a scene memory that is not assigned to a Program Change is recalled, a System Exclu-
sive Parameter Change Scene Recall message is transmitted. See “System Exclusive
Parameter Control” on page 231 for more information.
01V—Owner’s Manual
228 Chapter 17—MIDI
R R
14 16 14 16
IN OUT IN OUT
2TR 2TR
PHONES PHONES
PAD PAD
26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 15/16 MONITOR 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 15/16 MONITOR
2TR IN 2TR IN 2TR IN 2TR IN
–16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 +10 –20 +10 –20 0 10 0 10 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 +10 –20 +10 –20 0 10 0 10
+10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 GAIN GAIN LEVEL LEVEL +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 GAIN GAIN LEVEL LEVEL
MONITOR MONITOR
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13/14 15/16 OUT PHONES 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13/14 15/16 OUT PHONES
MIDI
FADER MODE –42 FADER MODE –42
EFFECT 1 EFFECT 2 OPTION I/O REMOTE G LOW –48 EFFECT 1 EFFECT 2 OPTION I/O REMOTE G LOW –48
1 RETURN 2 1 RETURN 2
HOME HOME
1
17
SEL
2
18
SEL
3
19
SEL
4
20
SEL
5
21
SEL
6
22
SEL
7
23
SEL
8
24
SEL
9
SEL
10
SEL
11
SEL
12
SEL
13/14 15/16
SEL SEL
STEREO
MASTER
SEL
1 RETURN 2
SEL SEL SOLO
(Program Change #10) 1
17
SEL
2
18
SEL
19
SEL
3
20
SEL
4
21
SEL
5
22
SEL
6 7
23
SEL
24
SEL
8
SEL
9 10
SEL
11
SEL
12
SEL
13/14 15/16
SEL SEL
STEREO
MASTER
SEL
1 RETURN 2
SEL SEL SOLO
SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO
ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON MEMORY ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON MEMORY
6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 0 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 0
–5 –5
0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 –10 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 –10
–15 –15
5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5
–20 –20
CURSOR CURSOR
10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10
–30 –30
20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 –40 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 –40
–50 –50
40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40
60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 –70 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 –70
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
– ∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
– ∞
ENTER ENTER
In the following example, program, or patch #5 is selected on the MIDI keyboard and
MIDI Program Change #5 is transmitted, hence scene memory #5 is recalled on the
01V. This assumes that the initial Program Change assignment table is being used. By
editing the Program Change to scene memory assignments, Program Change #5 could
be used to recall a different scene memory on the 01V.
01V
PHANTOM +48V OFF ON PHANTOM +48V OFF ON
INPUT (BAL)
–10dBV (UNBAL)
13 15 L
R
14 16
IN OUT
2TR
PHONES
PAD
26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 15/16 MONITOR
2TR IN 2TR IN
–16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 +10 –20 +10 –20 0 10 0 10
+10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 GAIN GAIN LEVEL LEVEL
MONITOR
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13/14 15/16 OUT PHONES
EQ HIGH L STEREO R
PAN CLIP
UTILITY MIDI SETUP VIEW –3
–6
PAN HI-MID
FUNCTION –9
–12
PAN/ F F –15
DYNAMICS EQ/ATT Ø/DELAY ROUTING MEMORY –18
G LO-MID –24
–30
SELECTED CHANNEL
AUX 1 AUX 2 AUX 3 AUX 4
HOME
SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO
ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON MEMORY
–1/DEC +1/INC
PARAMETER
6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 0
–5
0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 –10
–15
5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5
–20
CURSOR
10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10
–30
20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 –40
–50
40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40
60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 –70
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
– ∞
ENTER
In the following example, Program Change #26 has been entered into a song on the
MIDI sequencer. When the song is played, MIDI Program Change #26 is transmitted
at the specified location and scene memory #26 is recalled automatically on the 01V.
Since the 01V outputs Program Change messages when mix scenes are recalled, mix
scene recalls can be recorded to the MIDI sequencer in real time.
01V
PHANTOM +48V OFF ON PHANTOM +48V OFF ON
INPUT (BAL)
–10dBV (UNBAL)
13 15 L
R
14 16
MONITOR
2TR IN
2TR
OUT
PHONES
–16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 +10 –20 +10 –20 0 10 0 10
+10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 GAIN GAIN LEVEL LEVEL
MONITOR
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13/14 15/16 OUT PHONES
EQ HIGH L STEREO R
MIDI
PAN CLIP
UTILITY MIDI SETUP VIEW –3
–6
PAN HI-MID
FUNCTION –9
–12
PAN/ F F –15
DYNAMICS EQ/ATT Ø/DELAY ROUTING MEMORY –18
G LO-MID –24
–30
–36
FADER MODE –42
HOME
AUX 2 AUX 3 AUX 4
SELECTED CHANNEL
SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO
ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON MEMORY
–1/DEC +1/INC
PARAMETER
6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 0
–5
0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 –10
–15
5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5
–20
CURSOR
10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10
–30
20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 –40
–50
40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40
60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 –70
∞ ∞ ∞ ∞ ∞ ∞ ∞ ∞ ∞ ∞ ∞ ∞ ∞ ∞ –∞
ENTER
01V—Owner’s Manual
Control Change Parameter Control 229
2. Use the cursor buttons to select the CTL CHG. column, and then use the
PARAMETER wheel or [–1/DEC] and [+1/INC] buttons to select a Control
Change.
Since Control Changes 0 and 32 are used in conjunction with Program Change and
Bank Select messages, some MIDI sequencers may not record these Control Changes
correctly. In this case, set Control Changes 0 and 32 to NO ASSIGN.
3. Use the right cursor button to select the PARAMETER columns and the
PARAMETER wheel or [–1/DEC] and [+1/INC] buttons to select parame-
ters.
A parameter to Control Change assignment table is
provided on page 274. To reset the assignments to their
initial settings, use the cursor buttons to select the INI-
TIALIZE switch, and then press the [ENTER] button.
The dialog box shown here appears. Choose DEFAULT
to initialize.
The P.MIX 01 and 03D switches are used to configure Control Changes for use with the
Yamaha Programmable Mixer 01 or Yamaha 03D Digital Mixer. Parameter to Control
Change assignment tables for these are provided on page 277.
The current parameter to Control Change assignment table can be stored to an external
MIDI device, such as a MIDI data filer, using MIDI Bulk Dump. See “Bulk Dump” on
page 232 for more information.
01V—Owner’s Manual
230 Chapter 17—MIDI
When a Control Change message is received while MIDI page 3 is displayed, that Con-
trol Change is selected automatically, making it easy to determine which Control
Change is being transmitted when, say, the slider of an external MIDI controller is oper-
ated.
R R
14 16 14 16
IN OUT IN OUT
2TR 2TR
PHONES PHONES
PAD PAD
26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 15/16 MONITOR 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 15/16 MONITOR
2TR IN 2TR IN 2TR IN 2TR IN
–16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 +10 –20 +10 –20 0 10 0 10 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 +10 –20 +10 –20 0 10 0 10
+10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 GAIN GAIN LEVEL LEVEL +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 GAIN GAIN LEVEL LEVEL
MONITOR MONITOR
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13/14 15/16 OUT PHONES 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13/14 15/16 OUT PHONES
MIDI
FADER MODE –42 FADER MODE –42
EFFECT 1 EFFECT 2 OPTION I/O REMOTE G LOW –48 EFFECT 1 EFFECT 2 OPTION I/O REMOTE G LOW –48
1 RETURN 2 1 RETURN 2
HOME HOME
1
17
SEL
2
18
SEL
3
19
SEL
4
20
SEL
5
21
SEL
6
22
SEL
7
23
SEL
8
24
SEL
9
SEL
10
SEL
11
SEL
12
SEL
13/14 15/16
SEL SEL
STEREO
MASTER
SEL
1 RETURN 2
SEL SEL SOLO
(Control Change #27) 1
17
SEL
2
18
SEL
3
19
SEL
4
20
SEL
5
21
SEL
6
22
SEL
7
23
SEL
8
24
SEL
9
SEL
10
SEL
11
SEL
12
SEL
13/14 15/16
SEL SEL
STEREO
MASTER
SEL
1 RETURN 2
SEL SEL SOLO
SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO
ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON MEMORY ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON MEMORY
6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 0 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 0
–5 –5
0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 –10 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 –10
–15 –15
5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5
–20 –20
CURSOR CURSOR
10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10
–30 –30
20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 –40 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 –40
–50 –50
40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40
60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 –70 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 –70
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
– ∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
– ∞
ENTER ENTER
INPUT (BAL)
–10dBV (UNBAL)
13 15 L
R
14 16
IN OUT
2TR
PHONES
PAD
26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 15/16 MONITOR
2TR IN 2TR IN
–16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 +10 –20 +10 –20 0 10 0 10
+10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 GAIN GAIN LEVEL LEVEL
MONITOR
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13/14 15/16 OUT PHONES
MIDI keyboard
DIGITAL MIXING CONSOLE
EQ HIGH L STEREO R
PAN CLIP
UTILITY MIDI SETUP VIEW –3
–6
PAN HI-MID
FUNCTION –9
–12
PAN/ F F –15
DYNAMICS EQ/ATT Ø/DELAY ROUTING MEMORY
SELECTED CHANNEL
AUX 1 AUX 2 AUX 3 AUX 4
HOME
SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO
ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON MEMORY
–1/DEC +1/INC
PARAMETER
6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 0
–5
0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 –10
–15
5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5
–20
CURSOR
10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10
–30
20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 –40
–50
40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40
60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 –70
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
– ∞
ENTER
01V—Owner’s Manual
System Exclusive Parameter Control 231
In the following example, input channel 5 fader movements are recorded in real time
to a MIDI sequencer using Control Change #5. During playback, the sequencer trans-
mits Control Change #5 messages back to the 01V and fader 5 moves accordingly. This
technique can also be used with [ON] buttons, panpots, and effects, providing auto-
mated mixing.
01V
PHANTOM +48V OFF ON PHANTOM +48V OFF ON
INPUT (BAL)
–10dBV (UNBAL)
13 15 L
R
14 16
MONITOR
2TR IN
OUT
PHONES
1
–16 –60
+10 GAIN –34
2
–16 –60
+10 GAIN –34
3
–16 –60
+10 GAIN –34
4
–16 –60
+10 GAIN –34
5
–16 –60
+10 GAIN –34
6
–16 –60
+10 GAIN –34
7
–16 –60
+10 GAIN –34
8
–16 –60
+10 GAIN –34
9
–16 –60
+10 GAIN –34
10
–16 –60
+10 GAIN –34
11
–16 –60
+10 GAIN –34
12
+10
13/14
GAIN
–20 +10
15/16
GAIN
–20 0
LEVEL
MONITOR
OUT
10 0
LEVEL
PHONES
10
FUNCTION
PAN
PAN
EQ HIGH
HI-MID
L STEREO R
CLIP
–3
–6
–9
–12
PAN/ F F –15
DYNAMICS EQ/ATT Ø/DELAY ROUTING MEMORY –18
G LO-MID –24
–30
–36
FADER MODE –42
EFFECT 1 EFFECT 2 OPTION I/O REMOTE G LOW –48
1 RETURN 2
SELECTED CHANNEL
AUX 1 AUX 2 AUX 3 AUX 4
Playback HOME
SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO
–1/DEC +1/INC
PARAMETER
6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 0
–5
0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 –10
–15
5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5
–20
CURSOR
10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10
–30
20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 –40
–50
40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40
60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 –70
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
– ∞
ENTER
01V—Owner’s Manual
232 Chapter 17—MIDI
Bulk Dump
01V scene memories, library programs, and setup data can be transferred to another
MIDI device using System Exclusive Bulk Dump. This can be used to back up impor-
tant 01V data to a MIDI data filer or controlling computer, or to exchange data between
01Vs.
The 01V can transmit MIDI System Exclusive Bulk Dump messages at anytime. In
order for the 01V to respond to Bulk Dump requests from other MIDI devices, the
BULK Rx switch on MIDI page 1 must be turned on. See “MIDI Setup” on page 224 for
more information.
1. Use the [MIDI] button to locate MIDI page 4, as shown below.
2. Use the cursor buttons to select a CATEGORY switch, and press the
[ENTER] button to select it.
The switch of the selected category appears highlighted.
3. For the SCENE MEM., LIBRARY, and REMOTE categories, use the cursor
buttons, PARAMETER wheel, and [–1/DEC] and [+1/INC] buttons to set
the TYPE, FROM, and TO parameters.
Data Type Type Range Description
ALL — — All the following data
01V setup data (all current set-
SETUP MEM. — —
tings)
MIDI page 2 settings (scene
PGM. TABLE — — memory to Program Change
assignment table)
MIDI page 3 settings (parame-
CTL. TABLE — — ter to Control Change assign-
ment table)
Scene memories (EDIT is the
SCENE MEM. — EDIT, 1–99
Edit Buffer)
EQ 41–80 EQ library user programs
LIBRARY DYNA 41–80 Dynamics library user programs
EFF 43–99 Effects library user programs
INTP Banks 1–4 REMOTE page 1 banks
REMOTE MMC ALL (locate points 1–6) REMOTE page 2 locate points
UDEF Banks 1–4 REMOTE page 3 banks
4. Use the cursor buttons to select the REQUEST or TRANSMIT switch, and
then press the [ENTER] button.
When REQUEST is used, the 01V transmits a MIDI Bulk Dump request message. The
receiving device then transmits the requested Bulk Dump data to the 01V. When
TRANSMIT is used, the 01V transmits the selected data category via Bulk Dump.
01V—Owner’s Manual
Bulk Dump 233
R R
14 16 14 16
IN OUT IN OUT
2TR 2TR
PHONES PHONES
PAD PAD
26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 15/16 MONITOR 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 15/16 MONITOR
2TR IN 2TR IN 2TR IN 2TR IN
–16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 +10 –20 +10 –20 0 10 0 10 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 +10 –20 +10 –20 0 10 0 10
+10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 GAIN GAIN LEVEL LEVEL +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 GAIN GAIN LEVEL LEVEL
MONITOR MONITOR
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13/14 15/16 OUT PHONES 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13/14 15/16 OUT PHONES
HOME HOME
1
17
SEL
2
18
SEL
3
19
SEL
4
20
SEL
5
21
SEL
6
22
SEL
7
23
SEL
8
24
SEL
9
SEL
10
SEL
11
SEL
12
SEL
13/14 15/16
SEL SEL
STEREO
MASTER
SEL SEL
1 RETURN 2
SEL SOLO
(Scene memories and 1
17
SEL
2
18
SEL
3
19
SEL
4
20
SEL
5
21
SEL
6
22
SEL
7
23
SEL
8
24
SEL
9
SEL
10
SEL
11
SEL
12
SEL
13/14 15/16
SEL SEL
STEREO
MASTER
SEL
1 RETURN 2
SEL SEL SOLO
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON MEMORY
effects programs) SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON MEMORY
6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 0 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 0
–5 –5
0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 –10 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 –10
–15 –15
5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5
–20 –20
CURSOR CURSOR
10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10
–30 –30
20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 –40 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 –40
–50 –50
40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40
60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 –70 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 –70
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
– ∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
– ∞
ENTER ENTER
In the following example, all data from the 01V is transferred to a MIDI data filer. The
storage device could also be a computer running software with Bulk data management
features. In order to transfer Bulk Dump data from the MIDI data filer back to the 01V,
the BULK Rx switch on MIDI page 1 must be turned on. See “MIDI Setup” on page 224
for more information.
01V
PHANTOM +48V OFF ON PHANTOM +48V OFF ON
INPUT (BAL)
–10dBV (UNBAL)
13 15 L
R
14 16
IN OUT
2TR
PHONES
PAD
26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 15/16 MONITOR
2TR IN 2TR IN
–16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 +10 –20 +10 –20 0 10 0 10
+10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 GAIN GAIN LEVEL LEVEL
MONITOR
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13/14 15/16 OUT PHONES
FUNCTION
PAN
PAN
EQ HIGH
HI-MID
L STEREO R
CLIP
–3
–6
–9
–12
MIDI Bulk Dump (All data)
PAN/ F F –15
DYNAMICS EQ/ATT Ø/DELAY ROUTING MEMORY –18
G LO-MID –24
–30
–36
FADER MODE –42
SELECTED CHANNEL
AUX 1 AUX 2 AUX 3 AUX 4
HOME
SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO
ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON
MIDI OUT
MEMORY
–1/DEC
PARAMETER
+1/INC
MIDI IN
6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 0
–5
0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 –10
–15
5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5
–20
CURSOR
10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10
–30
20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 –40
–50
40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40
60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 –70
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
– ∞
ENTER
01V—Owner’s Manual
234 Chapter 17—MIDI
Local Control
The MIDI Local Control function can be used to control a remote 01V. Normally, the
01V controls (faders, buttons, rotary controls, and display pages) set the 01V’s internal
parameters. When Local Control is turned off, the internal parameters remain the same
when controls are operated but the System Exclusive Parameter Change messages that
the 01V tramsits can be used to control a remote 01V. Controllable parameters include
all those that can be stored in mix scenes and the solo and monitor setings. When Local
Control is turned off, the parameter values displayed on the local 01V are in fact those
of the remote 01V. In addition, the meters on the local 01V display the signals levels of
the remote 01V. This is useful when two 01Vs are cascaded together. See “Cascading
01Vs” on page 214 for more information.
1. Use the [MIDI] button to locate MIDI page 5, as shown below.
2. Use the cursor buttons to select the LOCAL CONTROL switch, and then
press the [ENTER] button.
Local Control is turned off and MIDI page 5 appears, as shown below.
While Local Control is turned off, the function area of the display
appears highlighted, as shown here, serving as a reminder that Local
Control is off.
The TRANSMIT and REQUEST functions are used to match local and
remote settings when 01Vs are first connected. The TRANSMIT func-
tion transmits the local 01V CONTROLLER settings to the remote 01V. The REQUEST
function requests the parameter settings of the remote 01V and sets the local 01V CON-
TROLLER accordingly. The internal parameters of the local 01V are unaffected by
either function.
For scene memories, the local 01V stores and recalls its own parameter settings regard-
less of the Local Control function.
Be aware that when Local Control is being used to control a remote 01V (i.e., Local
Control is off on the local 01V), remote control may be disrupted temporarily due to
wordclock abnormalities on the local 01V. Also, if parameters are adjusted directly on
the remote 01V, the meters on the local 01V may not display levels correctly.
Local Control cannot be turned off while a mix-scene crossfade is in progress (Fade
Time), and a warning message appears if you try to do so. Local Control can, however,
be turned on while a mix-scene fade is in progress.
01V—Owner’s Manual
Local Control 235
In the following example, 01V-A (remote) and 01V-B (local) are cascaded together for
48-channel digital mixing. Using the Local Control function, both 01Vs can be con-
trolled using the faders, buttons, rotary controls, and display pages of 01V-B. Even the
signal levels of 01V-A can be metered on 01V-B. To control 01-B, the Local Control
function on 01V-B is turned ON. To control 01V-A, the Local Control function on
01V-B is turned OFF. Both 01Vs should be set to the same PORT (MIDI or TO HOST),
and the MIDI receive channel (Rx) on 01V-A should match the MIDI transmit channel
(Tx) on 01V-B. See “MIDI Setup” on page 224 for more information.
R R
DIGITAL STEREO
14 16 14 16
IN OUT IN OUT
2TR 2TR
PHONES PHONES
PAD PAD
COAXIAL OUT
26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 15/16 MONITOR 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 15/16 MONITOR
2TR IN 2TR IN 2TR IN 2TR IN
–16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 +10 –20 +10 –20 0 10 0 10 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 +10 –20 +10 –20 0 10 0 10
+10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 GAIN GAIN LEVEL LEVEL +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 GAIN GAIN LEVEL LEVEL
MONITOR MONITOR
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13/14 15/16 OUT PHONES 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13/14 15/16 OUT PHONES
EQ HIGH L STEREO R
DIGITAL STEREO DIGITAL MIXING CONSOLE
EQ HIGH L STEREO R
PAN CLIP PAN CLIP
COAXIAL IN
UTILITY MIDI SETUP VIEW –3 UTILITY MIDI SETUP VIEW –3
–6 –6
PAN HI-MID PAN HI-MID
FUNCTION –9 FUNCTION –9
–12 –12
PAN/ F F –15 PAN/ F F –15
DYNAMICS EQ/ATT Ø/DELAY ROUTING MEMORY –18 DYNAMICS EQ/ATT Ø/DELAY ROUTING MEMORY –18
G LO-MID –24 G LO-MID –24
–30 –30
–36 –36
FADER MODE –42 FADER MODE –42
HOME HOME
SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO
ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON MEMORY ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON MEMORY
6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 0
–1/DEC
PARAMETER
+1/INC
TO HOST 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 0
–1/DEC
PARAMETER
+1/INC
–5 –5
0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 –10 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 –10
–15 –15
5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5
–20 –20
CURSOR CURSOR
TO HOST
10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10
–30 –30
20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 –40 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 –40
–50 –50
40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40
60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 –70 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 –70
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
– ∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
– ∞
ENTER ENTER
01V—Owner’s Manual
236 Chapter 17—MIDI
While this page is displayed, controls other than [ON] buttons 1 through 6 and [SEL]
buttons 1 through 6 are disabled.
2. Use the cursor buttons to select the DEVICE No. parameter, and the
PARAMETER wheel or [–1/DEC] and [+1/INC] buttons to select a device
number.
The device number, which can be set from 1 through 127 or ALL, should be set to
match that of the recorder you want to control. When set to ALL, all MMC-compatible
recorders connected can be controlled together.
3. Use [ON] buttons 1 through 6 to transmit the following transport com-
mands to a recorder.
On Button Function MMC Command Value
1 Rewind 05
2 Fast Forward 04
3 Stop 01
4 Play 02
5 Pause 09
6 Record 06
4. Use the cursor buttons and PARAMETER wheel or [–1/DEC] and [+1/INC]
buttons to set the locate times in hours, minutes, seconds, and frames.
5. Use [SEL] buttons 1 through 6 to transmit the locate commands to the
recorder.
Locate points can be stored using MIDI Bulk Dump. See “Bulk Dump” on page 232 for
more information.
01V—Owner’s Manual
MIDI Machine Control 237
INPUT (BAL)
–10dBV (UNBAL)
13 15
Personal computer
L
R
14 16
IN OUT
–16 –60
+10 GAIN –34
1
–16 –60
+10 GAIN –34
2
–16 –60
+10 GAIN –34
3
–16 –60
+10 GAIN –34
4
–16 –60
+10 GAIN –34
5
–16 –60
+10 GAIN –34
6
–16 –60
+10 GAIN –34
7
–16 –60
+10 GAIN –34
8
–16 –60
+10 GAIN –34
9
–16 –60
+10 GAIN –34
10
–16 –60
+10 GAIN –34
11
–16 –60
+10 GAIN –34
12
+10
13/14
GAIN
–20 +10
15/16
GAIN
–20 0
LEVEL
MONITOR
OUT
10 0
LEVEL
PHONES
10
Digital audio
DIGITAL MIXING CONSOLE
EQ HIGH L STEREO R
UTILITY
DYNAMICS
MIDI
EQ/ATT
SETUP
Ø/DELAY
VIEW
PAN/
ROUTING
FUNCTION
MEMORY
PAN
F F
PAN
HI-MID
CLIP
–3
–6
–9
–12
–15
–18
OPTION I/O
G LO-MID –24
–30
–36
FADER MODE –42
SELECTED CHANNEL
AUX 1 AUX 2 AUX 3 AUX 4
HOME
SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO
ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON MEMORY
–1/DEC
PARAMETER
+1/INC
MIDI Machine Control
6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 0
–5
0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 –10
20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 –40
–50
40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40
60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 –70
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
– ∞
ENTER
Digital multitrack
INPUT (BAL)
–10dBV (UNBAL)
13 15 L
R
14 16
PAD
26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 15/16
IN
2TR
MONITOR
OUT
PHONES
DIGITAL IN
2TR IN 2TR IN
–16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 +10 –20 +10 –20 0 10 0 10
+10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 GAIN GAIN LEVEL LEVEL
MONITOR
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13/14 15/16 OUT PHONES
L STEREO R
OPTION I/O
EQ HIGH
PAN CLIP
UTILITY MIDI SETUP VIEW –3
–6
PAN HI-MID
8-TRACK DIGITAL
FUNCTION –9
–12
PAN/ F F –15
DYNAMICS EQ/ATT Ø/DELAY ROUTING MEMORY –18
DIGITAL OUT
G LO-MID –24
–30
–36
FADER MODE –42
AUX 1
HOME
AUX 2 AUX 3 AUX 4
SELECTED CHANNEL
MIDI IN
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13/14 15/16 STEREO 1 RETURN 2
17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 MASTER
SEL SEL SEL SEL SEL SEL SEL SEL SEL SEL SEL SEL SEL SEL SEL SEL SEL SOLO
SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO
ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON MEMORY
–1/DEC +1/INC
PARAMETER
MIDI OUT
6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 0
–5
0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 –10
–15
5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5
–20
CURSOR
10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10
–30
20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 –40
–50
40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40
ENTER
01V—Owner’s Manual
238 Chapter 17—MIDI
While this page is displayed, the [SOLO] and [ON] buttons and faders on channels 1
through 16 and Master transmit the assigned MIDI data when operated. Other controls
are disabled.
2. Use the [SEL] buttons to select channels 1 through 16 or Master, and the
cursor buttons and [ENTER] button to select the SOLO, ON, and FADER
switches.
Controls can also be selected simply by operating them. For example, operating chan-
nel fader 5 automatically selects it. The switch of the selected control appears high-
lighted. The Master channel does not feature a [SOLO] button.
3. Use the cursor buttons to select the DATA parameters, and the PARAM-
ETER wheel or [–1/DEC] and [+1/INC] buttons to set them.
The following hexadecimal DATA values can be set.
Hex: 00–FF
SW: [SOLO] and [ON] buttons (7F for ON, 00 for OFF)
FAD: Faders (00–7F)
END: Completes the command
4. Use the cursor buttons to select the BANK switches, and then press the
[ENTER] button to activate the selected bank.
The switch of the active bank appears highlighted.
In UNLATCH mode, the [SOLO] and [ON] buttons function as momentary switches,
and the specified data is transmitted when they’re pressed and then released. SW is
transmitted as 7F when buttons are pressed, and 00 when they’re released.
In LATCH mode, the [SOLO] and [ON] buttons function as latching switches (i.e., they
remain on when pressed), and the specified data is transmitted only when they’re
pressed. SW is transmitted as 7F when buttons are pressed, and 00 is transmitted when
the buttons are pressed again.
When a Control Change message is received while REMOTE page 3 is displayed, its
value appears in the DATA boxes, making it easy to determine which Control Change
is being transmitted when, say, the slider of an external MIDI controller is operated.
Custom assignments are stored when other banks are selected, and banks can be stored
using MIDI Bulk Dump. See “Bulk Dump” on page 232 for more information.
01V—Owner’s Manual
Linking 01Vs 239
To reset a bank back to its initial assignments, make it the active bank, select the INI-
TIALIZE switch, and then press the [ENTER] button. A confirmation dialog box
appears. Select OK, and then press the [ENTER] button to confirm your action. The
selected bank is reset to its initial assignments.
In the following example, REMOTE page 3 is displayed while the modulation control-
ler on the MIDI keyboard is operated. The 01V detects Modulation Controller Control
Change #1 and assigns it to the selected 01V fader. Then, when the fader is operated,
the 01V transmits Control Change #1 messages back to the MIDI keyboard. The 01V
must be set to receive MIDI Control Change messages. See “MIDI Setup” on page 224
for more information.
01V
PHANTOM +48V OFF ON PHANTOM +48V OFF ON
INPUT (BAL)
–10dBV (UNBAL)
13 15 L
R
14 16
IN OUT
2TR
PHONES
PAD
26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 15/16 MONITOR
2TR IN 2TR IN
–16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 +10 –20 +10 –20 0 10 0 10
+10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 GAIN GAIN LEVEL LEVEL
MONITOR
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13/14 15/16 OUT PHONES
FUNCTION
PAN
PAN
EQ HIGH
HI-MID
L STEREO R
CLIP
–3
–6
–9
–12
PAN/ F F –15
DYNAMICS EQ/ATT Ø/DELAY ROUTING MEMORY –18
G LO-MID –24
–30
–36
FADER MODE –42
EFFECT 1 EFFECT 2 OPTION I/O REMOTE G LOW –48
1 RETURN 2
HOME
AUX 2 AUX 3 AUX 4
SELECTED CHANNEL
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON MEMORY
–1/DEC +1/INC
PARAMETER
6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 0
–5
0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 –10
–15
5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5
–20
CURSOR
10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10
–30
20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 –40
–50
40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40
60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 –70
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
– ∞
ENTER
Linking 01Vs
The TO HOST connection links the two or more 01Vs together for simultaneous oper-
ation, so when, for example, the fader mode is set to Aux 1 on 01V-B, the fader mode
on 01V-A is also set to Aux 1, and vice versa. Other linked functions include
• Operations
Fader mode & Display page selection, Scene memory title edit, and Mix scene store
(including title) and recall
• Parameters
Solo, Metering point (HOME page 5), and Meter Peak Hold on/off
The LINK PORT parameter on MIDI page 1 should be set to HOST. See “MIDI Setup”
on page 224 for more information.
01V-A 01V-B
PHANTOM +48V OFF ON PHANTOM +48V OFF ON PHANTOM +48V OFF ON PHANTOM +48V OFF ON
R R
14 16 14 16
IN OUT IN OUT
2TR 2TR
PHONES PHONES
TO HOST
PAD PAD
26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 15/16 MONITOR 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 15/16 MONITOR
2TR IN 2TR IN 2TR IN 2TR IN
–16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 +10 –20 +10 –20 0 10 0 10 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 +10 –20 +10 –20 0 10 0 10
+10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 GAIN GAIN LEVEL LEVEL +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 GAIN GAIN LEVEL LEVEL
MONITOR MONITOR
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13/14 15/16 OUT PHONES 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13/14 15/16 OUT PHONES
EQ HIGH L STEREO R
TO HOST DIGITAL MIXING CONSOLE
EQ HIGH L STEREO R
PAN CLIP PAN CLIP
UTILITY MIDI SETUP VIEW –3 UTILITY MIDI SETUP VIEW –3
–6 –6
PAN HI-MID PAN HI-MID
FUNCTION –9 FUNCTION –9
–12 –12
PAN/ F F –15 PAN/ F F –15
DYNAMICS EQ/ATT Ø/DELAY ROUTING MEMORY –18 DYNAMICS EQ/ATT Ø/DELAY ROUTING MEMORY –18
G LO-MID –24 G LO-MID –24
–30 –30
–36 –36
FADER MODE –42 FADER MODE –42
HOME HOME
SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO
ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON MEMORY ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON MEMORY
6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 0 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 0
–5 –5
0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 –10 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 –10
–15 –15
5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5
–20 –20
CURSOR CURSOR
10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10
–30 –30
20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 –40 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 –40
–50 –50
40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40
60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 –70 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 –70
∞ ∞ ∞ ∞ ∞ ∞ ∞ ∞ ∞ ∞ ∞ ∞ ∞ ∞ –∞ ∞ ∞ ∞ ∞ ∞ ∞ ∞ ∞ ∞ ∞ ∞ ∞ ∞ ∞ –∞
ENTER ENTER
01V—Owner’s Manual
240 Chapter 17—MIDI
R R
14 16 14 16
IN OUT IN OUT
2TR 2TR
PHONES PHONES
PAD PAD
26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 15/16 MONITOR 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 15/16 MONITOR
2TR IN 2TR IN 2TR IN 2TR IN
–16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 +10 –20 +10 –20 0 10 0 10 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 +10 –20 +10 –20 0 10 0 10
+10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 GAIN GAIN LEVEL LEVEL +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 GAIN GAIN LEVEL LEVEL
MONITOR MONITOR
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13/14 15/16 OUT PHONES 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13/14 15/16 OUT PHONES
HOME HOME
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON MEMORY
MIDI OUT MIDI IN SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON MEMORY
6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 0 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 0
–5 –5
0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 –10 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 –10
10
20
5
10
20
5
10
20
5
10
20
5
10
20
5
10
20
5
10
20
5
10
20
5
10
20
10
20
5 5
10
20
5
10
20
5
10
20
10
20
5
–15
–20
–30
–40
CURSOR MIDI IN MIDI OUT 5
10
20
5
10
20
5
10
20
5
10
20
5
10
20
5
10
20
5
10
20
5
10
20
5
10
20
10
20
5 5
10
20
5
10
20
5
10
20
10
20
5
–15
–20
–30
–40
CURSOR
–50 –50
40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40
60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 –70 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 –70
∞ ∞ ∞ ∞ ∞ ∞ ∞ ∞ ∞ ∞ ∞ ∞ ∞ ∞ –∞ ∞ ∞ ∞ ∞ ∞ ∞ ∞ ∞ ∞ ∞ ∞ ∞ ∞ ∞ –∞
ENTER ENTER
01V—Owner’s Manual
System Examples 241
System Examples
18
In this chapter...
01V—Owner’s Manual
242 Chapter 18—System Examples
System Components
• 01V Digital Mixing Console
• MY8-AT Option I/O card
• 8-track digital tape recorder, or 8-track hard disk recorder, such as Alesis ADAT, Ale-
sis ADAT-XT, Alesis M20, Akai DR8, Akai DD8, Fostex D-90, or Fostex CX-8.
• Two ADAT optical cables
See “Installing Option I/O Cards” on page 218 for MY8-AT installation instructions.
Wordclock Configuration
For digital audio transfer, digital audio devices must be wordclock synchronized (see
“About Wordclocks” on page 206). In this example, the digital multitrack recorder is
wordclock master and the 01V and DAT recorder are wordclock slaves. The 01V derives
its wordclock from the Option I/O digital input. The DAT derives its wordclock from
the Digital Stereo Coaxial Out of the 01V. The wordclock frequency, which is the same
as the sampling rate, is set when the digital multitrack tape is formatted or first
recorded.
For digital recording from the DAT recorder to the digital multitrack recorder, the DAT
recorder must be configured as wordclock master and the 01V and digital multitrack
recorder as wordclock slaves. In this case, the 01V would derive its wordclock from the
Digital Stereo Coaxial In connection, and the digital multitrack recorder would derive
its wordclock from the 01V’s Option I/O connection. The sampling rate will be the
same as that used when the DAT tape was recorded. If a CD player is used instead of the
DAT, the sampling rate will be fixed at 44.1 kHz, the industry-standard for music CDs.
System Notes
• The digital IN and OUT connectors on the MY8-AT card are connected to the digital
multitrack recorder using ADAT optical cables.
• On an Alesis ADAT 8-Track Digital Audio Recorder, use the DIGITAL IN button to
select the optical digital input.
• Although the 01V is a four-bus mixer, a combination of bus outs, aux sends, and
channel direct outputs can be assigned to the digital outputs for eight-track simulta-
neous recording. See “Assigning Option I/O Digital Outputs” on page 219 for more
information.
01V—Owner’s Manual
01V & ADAT-Interface Recorder 243
Monitors
Power Amp
Headphones
Personal computer
running MIDI software
01V MONITOR PHONES
(wordclock slave) OUT Digital multitrack
PHANTOM +48V OFF ON
INPUT (BAL)
PHANTOM +48V OFF ON
13 15 L
–10dBV (UNBAL) (wordclock master)
14 16
R
IN
2TR
OUT OUT Digital in
PHONES
PAD
26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 15/16 MONITOR
2TR IN 2TR IN
–16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 +10 –20 +10 –20 0 10 0 10
+10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 GAIN GAIN LEVEL LEVEL
OPTION I/O
MONITOR
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13/14 15/16 OUT PHONES
ADAT
DIGITAL MIXING CONSOLE
EQ HIGH L STEREO R
PAN CLIP
UTILITY MIDI SETUP VIEW –3
–6
IN
PAN HI-MID
FUNCTION –9
Digital out
–12
PAN/ F F –15
DYNAMICS EQ/ATT Ø/DELAY ROUTING MEMORY –18
G LO-MID –24
–30
–36
FADER MODE –42
EFFECT 1 EFFECT 2 OPTION I/O REMOTE G LOW –48
1 RETURN 2
SELECTED CHANNEL
AUX 1 AUX 2 AUX 3 AUX 4
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON MEMORY
(wordclock slave)
MIDI IN OUT Digital in
DAT
–1/DEC +1/INC
PARAMETER
00.00.00.00
MIDI 6
5
6
5
6
5
6
5
6
5
6
5
6
5
6
5
6
5
6
5
6
5
6
5
6
5
6
5
0
–5
–10
–15
DIGITAL STEREO
interface
–20
COAXIAL
CURSOR
10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10
–30
20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 –40
–50
40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40
60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 –70
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
– ∞
1
17
2
18
3
19
4
20
5
21
6
22
7
23
8
24
9 10 11 12 13/14 15/16 STEREO
MASTER
IN Digital out
Drum machine
Guitar processor
MIDI IN
Tone generator
MIDI IN
Bass processor
MIDI keyboard
MIDI IN
MIDI OUT
Vocals Drums
01V—Owner’s Manual
244 Chapter 18—System Examples
System Components
• Two 01V Digital Mixing Consoles
• Two MY8-AT Option I/O cards
• Two 8-track digital tape recorders, or 8-track hard disk recorders, such as Alesis
ADAT, ADAT-XT, Alesis M20, Akai DR8, Akai DD8, Fostex D-90, or Fostex CX-8.
• Four ADAT optical cables
• ADAT sync cable
See “Installing Option I/O Cards” on page 218 for MY8-AT installation instructions.
Wordclock Configuration
For digital audio transfer, digital audio devices must be wordclock synchronized (see
“About Wordclocks” on page 206). In this example, digital multitrack recorder A is
wordclock master, while digital multitrack recorder B, the 01Vs, and DAT recorder are
wordclock slaves. Digital multitrack recorder B derives its wordclock from the sync con-
nection with recorder A. The 01Vs derive their wordclocks from their Option I/O dig-
ital inputs, and the DAT, from the Digital Stereo Coaxial Out of the 01V. The wordclock
frequency, which is the same as the sampling rate, is set when the digital multitrack tape
is formatted or first recorded.
For digital recording from the DAT recorder to the digital multitrack recorders, the
DAT recorder must be configured as wordclock master and the 01Vs and digital multi-
track recorders as wordclock slaves. The sampling rate will be the same as that used
when the DAT tape was recorded. If a CD player is used instead of the DAT, the sam-
pling rate will be fixed at 44.1 kHz, the industry-standard for music CDs.
System Notes
• The digital IN and OUT connectors on the MY8-AT cards are connected to the dig-
ital multitrack recorders using ADAT optical cables.
• On Alesis ADAT 8-Track Digital Audio Recorders, use the DIGITAL IN button to
select the optical digital input.
• Although the 01V is a four-bus mixer, a combination of bus outs, aux sends, and
channel direct outputs can be assigned to the digital outputs for eight-track simulta-
neous recording. See “Assigning Option I/O Digital Outputs” on page 219 for more
information.
01V—Owner’s Manual
Two 01Vs & two ADAT-Interface Recorders 245
Monitors
Power Amp
Headphones
Personal computer
running MIDI software
01V-A MONITOR PHONES
(wordclock slave) OUT Digital multitrack-A
PHANTOM +48V OFF ON
INPUT (BAL)
PHANTOM +48V OFF ON
13 15
–10dBV (UNBAL)
(wordclock master)
Digital in
L
14 16
R
IN
2TR
OUT
PHONES
OUT SYNC
OUT
PAD
26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 15/16 MONITOR
2TR IN 2TR IN
–16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 +10 –20 +10 –20 0 10 0 10
OPTION I/O
+10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 GAIN GAIN LEVEL LEVEL
ADAT
MONITOR
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13/14 15/16 OUT PHONES
EQ HIGH L STEREO R
PAN CLIP
UTILITY MIDI SETUP VIEW –3
IN
–6
PAN HI-MID
Digital out
FUNCTION –9
–12
PAN/ F F –15
DYNAMICS EQ/ATT Ø/DELAY ROUTING MEMORY –18
G LO-MID –24
–30
–36
FADER MODE –42
EFFECT 1 EFFECT 2 OPTION I/O REMOTE G LOW –48
1 RETURN 2
SELECTED CHANNEL
AUX 1 AUX 2 AUX 3 AUX 4
1
17
2
18
3
19
4
20
5
21
6
22
7
23
8
24
9 10 11 12 13/14 15/16 STEREO
MASTER
1 RETURN 2
DAT recorder
(wordclock slave)
SEL SEL SEL SEL SEL SEL SEL SEL SEL SEL SEL SEL SEL SEL SEL SEL SEL SOLO
SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO
Digital in
ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON MEMORY
MIDI IN OUT
DAT
–1/DEC +1/INC
PARAMETER
00.00.00.00
MIDI 6
0
6
0
6
0
6
0
6
0
6
0
6
0
6
0
6
0
6
0
6
0
6
0
6
0
6
0
0
–5
–10 DIGITAL STEREO
–15
interface
5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5
COAXIAL
–20
CURSOR
10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10
–30
20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 –40
–50
40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40
60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 –70
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
– ∞
1
17
2
18
3
19
4
20
5
21
6
22
7
23
8
24
9 10 11 12 13/14 15/16 STEREO
MASTER
IN Digital out
DIGITAL STEREO
TO HOST COAXIAL OUT Digital multitrack-B
PHANTOM +48V OFF ON
INPUT (BAL)
PHANTOM +48V OFF ON
13 15 L
–10dBV (UNBAL) (wordclock slave)
14 16
R
OUT Digital in
PAD
IN
2TR
OUT
PHONES SYNC
IN
26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 15/16 MONITOR
2TR IN 2TR IN
–16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 +10 –20 +10 –20 0 10 0 10
+10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 GAIN GAIN LEVEL LEVEL
OPTION I/O
MONITOR
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13/14 15/16 OUT PHONES
ADAT
DIGITAL MIXING CONSOLE
EQ HIGH L STEREO R
FUNCTION
PAN
PAN
HI-MID
CLIP
–3
–6
–9
IN Digital out
–12
PAN/ F F –15
DYNAMICS EQ/ATT Ø/DELAY ROUTING MEMORY –18
G LO-MID –24
–30
–36
FADER MODE –42
SELECTED CHANNEL
AUX 1 AUX 2 AUX 3 AUX 4
SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO
ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON MEMORY
01V-B
–1/DEC +1/INC
PARAMETER
6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 0
–5
(wordclock slave)
0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 –10
–15
5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5
–20
CURSOR
10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10
–30
20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 –40
–50
40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40
60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 –70
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
– ∞
ENTER
01V—Owner’s Manual
246 Chapter 18—System Examples
System Components
• 01V Digital Mixing Console
• MY8-TD Option I/O card
• 8-track digital tape recorder, or 8-track hard disk recorder, such as the Tascam DA-38
Tascam DA-88, Tascam DA-98, or Akai DD8.
• Tascam PW-88D digital audio cable
See “Installing Option I/O Cards” on page 218 for MY8-TD installation instructions.
Wordclock Configuration
For digital audio transfer, digital audio devices must be wordclock synchronized (see
“About Wordclocks” on page 206). In this example, the digital multitrack recorder is
wordclock master and the 01V and DAT recorder are wordclock slaves. The 01V derives
its wordclock from the Option I/O digital input. The DAT derives its wordclock from
the Digital Stereo Coaxial Out of the 01V. The wordclock frequency, which is the same
as the sampling rate, is set when the digital multitrack tape is formatted or first
recorded.
For digital recording from the DAT recorder to the digital multitrack recorder, the DAT
recorder must be configured as wordclock master and the 01V and digital multitrack
recorder as wordclock slaves. In this case, the 01V would derive its wordclock from the
Digital Stereo Coaxial In connection. Since the digital multitrack recorder cannot
derive a wordclock signal from its digital inputs, a BNC cable is used to supply a word-
clock signal from the 01V. (Note that this connection is only necessary when the digital
multitrack recorder is used as a wordclock slave.) The sampling rate will be the same as
that used when the DAT tape was recorded. If a CD player is used instead of the DAT,
the sampling rate will be fixed at 44.1 kHz, the industry-standard for music CDs.
System Notes
• The TDIF-1 connector on the MY8-TD is connected to the digital multitrack
recorder using a Tascam PW-88D digital audio cable.
• MY8-TD cards feature a device selector switch that should be set according to the
type of recorder connected. “EXT: 88” for DA-88. “INT: 38” for DA-38 or other
recorder.
• Although the 01V is a four-bus mixer, a combination of bus outs, aux sends, and
channel direct outputs can be assigned to the digital outputs for eight-track simulta-
neous recording. See “Assigning Option I/O Digital Outputs” on page 219 for more
information.
• The BNC wordclock connection from the 01V to the digital multitrack recorder is
only necessary when the digital multitrack recorder is used as a wordclock slave.
01V—Owner’s Manual
01V & Tascam-Interface Recorder 247
Monitors
Power Amp
Headphones
Personal computer
running MIDI software
01V PW-88D
MONITOR PHONES
(wordclock slave) OUT Digital multitrack
PHANTOM +48V OFF ON
INPUT (BAL)
PHANTOM +48V OFF ON
13 15 L
–10dBV (UNBAL)
TDIF-1 TDIF-1
(wordclock master)
R
14 16
IN OUT
2TR
PHONES
PAD
26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 15/16 MONITOR
2TR IN 2TR IN
OPTION I/O
–16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 +10 –20 +10 –20 0 10 0 10
+10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 GAIN GAIN LEVEL LEVEL
MONITOR
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13/14 15/16 OUT PHONES
FUNCTION
PAN
PAN
EQ HIGH
HI-MID
L STEREO R
CLIP
–3
–6
–9
8-TRACK DIGITAL
WORD SYNC IN
–12
PAN/ F F –15
DYNAMICS EQ/ATT Ø/DELAY ROUTING MEMORY –18
G LO-MID –24
–30
–36
FADER MODE –42
CLOCK
EFFECT 1 EFFECT 2 OPTION I/O REMOTE G LOW –48
1 RETURN 2
SELECTED CHANNEL
AUX 1 AUX 2 AUX 3 AUX 4
Serial port
HOME
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON MEMORY
(wordclock slave)
MIDI IN OUT Digital in
DAT
–1/DEC +1/INC
PARAMETER
00.00.00.00
MIDI 6
5
6
5
6
5
6
5
6
5
6
5
6
5
6
5
6
5
6
5
6
5
6
5
6
5
6
5
0
–5
–10
–15
DIGITAL STEREO
interface
–20
COAXIAL
CURSOR
10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10
–30
20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 –40
–50
40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40
60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 –70
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
– ∞
1
17
2
18
3
19
4
20
5
21
6
22
7
23
8
24
9 10 11 12 13/14 15/16 STEREO
MASTER
IN Digital out
Drum machine
Guitar processor
MIDI IN
Tone generator
MIDI IN
Bass processor
MIDI keyboard
MIDI IN
MIDI OUT
Vocals Drums
01V—Owner’s Manual
248 Chapter 18—System Examples
System Components
• Two 01V Digital Mixing Consoles
• Two MY8-TD Option I/O cards
• Two 8-track digital tape recorders, or 8-track hard disk recorders, such as the Tascam
DA-38 Tascam DA-88, Tascam DA-98, or Akai DD8.
• Two Tascam PW-88D digital audio cables
• Tascam PW-88S sync cable
See “Installing Option I/O Cards” on page 218 for MY8-TD installation instructions.
Wordclock Configuration
For digital audio transfer, digital audio devices must be wordclock synchronized (see
“About Wordclocks” on page 206). In this example, digital multitrack recorder A is
wordclock master, while digital multitrack recorder B, the 01Vs, and DAT recorder are
wordclock slaves. Digital multitrack recorder B derives its wordclock from the sync con-
nection with recorder A. The 01Vs derive their wordclocks from their Option I/O dig-
ital inputs, and the DAT, from the Digital Stereo Coaxial Out of the 01V. The wordclock
frequency, which is the same as the sampling rate, is set when the digital multitrack tape
is formatted or first recorded.
For digital recording from the DAT recorder to the digital multitrack recorders, the
DAT recorder must be configured as wordclock master and the 01Vs and digital multi-
track recorders as wordclock slaves. The sampling rate will be the same as that used
when the DAT tape was recorded. If a CD player is used instead of the DAT, the sam-
pling rate will be fixed at 44.1 kHz, the industry-standard for music CDs.
System Notes
• The TDIF-1 connectors on the MY8-TD cards are connected to the digital multi-
track recorders using Tascam PW-88D digital audio cables.
• MY8-TD cards feature a device selector switch that should be set according to the
type of recorder connected. “EXT: 88” for DA-88. “INT: 38” for DA-38 or other
recorder.
• Although the 01V is a four-bus mixer, a combination of bus outs, aux sends, and
channel direct outputs can be assigned to the digital outputs for eight-track simulta-
neous recording. See “Assigning Option I/O Digital Outputs” on page 219 for more
information.
01V—Owner’s Manual
Two 01Vs & two Tascam-Interface Recorders 249
Monitors
Power Amp
Headphones
Personal computer
running MIDI software
01V-A MONITOR PHONES
(wordclock slave) OUT Digital multitrack-A
PW-88D
PHANTOM +48V OFF ON
INPUT (BAL)
PHANTOM +48V OFF ON
13 15 L
–10dBV (UNBAL)
(wordclock master)
R
SYNC
14 16
IN OUT
2TR
TDIF-1 TDIF-1
PHONES
OUT
PAD
26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 26dB 15/16 MONITOR
2TR IN 2TR IN
–16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 +10 –20 +10 –20 0 10 0 10
+10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 GAIN GAIN LEVEL LEVEL
MONITOR
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13/14 15/16 OUT PHONES
OPTION I/O
DIGITAL MIXING CONSOLE
SELECTED CHANNEL
AUX 1 AUX 2 AUX 3 AUX 4
1
17
2
18
3
19
4
20
5
21
6
22
7
23
8
24
9 10 11 12 13/14 15/16 STEREO
MASTER
1 RETURN 2
DAT recorder
(wordclock slave)
SEL SEL SEL SEL SEL SEL SEL SEL SEL SEL SEL SEL SEL SEL SEL SEL SEL SOLO
SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO
Digital in
ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON MEMORY
MIDI IN OUT
DAT
–1/DEC +1/INC
PARAMETER
00.00.00.00
MIDI 6
0
6
0
6
0
6
0
6
0
6
0
6
0
6
0
6
0
6
0
6
0
6
0
6
0
6
0
0
–5
–10 DIGITAL STEREO
–15
interface
5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5
COAXIAL
–20
CURSOR
10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10
–30
20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 –40
–50
40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40
60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 –70
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
– ∞
1
17
2
18
3
19
4
20
5
21
6
22
7
23
8
24
9 10 11 12 13/14 15/16 STEREO
MASTER
IN Digital out
DIGITAL STEREO
TO HOST COAXIAL OUT Digital multitrack-B
PHANTOM +48V OFF ON
INPUT (BAL)
PHANTOM +48V OFF ON
13 15 L
–10dBV (UNBAL) (wordclock slave)
R
14 16
PAD
IN
2TR
OUT
PHONES
–16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 +10 –20 +10 –20 0 10 0 10
+10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 GAIN GAIN LEVEL LEVEL
MONITOR
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13/14 15/16 OUT PHONES
OPTION I/O
MIDI IN UTILITY MIDI SETUP VIEW
FUNCTION
PAN
PAN
EQ HIGH
HI-MID
L STEREO R
CLIP
–3
–6
–9
8-TRACK DIGITAL
–12
PAN/ F F –15
DYNAMICS EQ/ATT Ø/DELAY ROUTING MEMORY –18
G LO-MID –24
–30
–36
FADER MODE –42
SELECTED CHANNEL
AUX 1 AUX 2 AUX 3 AUX 4
SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO SOLO
ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON MEMORY
01V-B
–1/DEC +1/INC
PARAMETER
6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 0
–5
(wordclock slave)
0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 –10
–15
5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5
–20
CURSOR
10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10
–30
20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 –40
–50
40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40
60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 –70
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
– ∞
ENTER
01V—Owner’s Manual
250 Chapter 18—System Examples
System Components
• 01V Digital Mixing Console
• MY8-AE Option I/O card
• Pro Tools system with Digidesign 888 I/O Audio Interface
• XLR to 25-pin D-sub splitter box (or 25-pin D-sub to XLR break-out cable)
• 25-pin D-sub cable, 50-pin Pro Tools cable
See “Installing Option I/O Cards” on page 218 for MY8-AE installation instructions.
Wordclock Configuration
For digital audio transfer, digital audio devices must be wordclock synchronized (see
“About Wordclocks” on page 206). In this example, Pro Tools is wordclock master and
the 01V and DAT recorder are wordclock slaves. The 01V derives its wordclock from the
Option I/O digital input. The DAT derives its wordclock from the Digital Stereo Coaxial
Out of the 01V. The wordclock frequency, which is the same as the sampling rate, is set
by Pro Tools.
For digital recording from the DAT recorder to Pro Tools, the DAT recorder must be
configured as wordclock master and the 01V and Pro Tools as wordclock slaves. In this
case, the 01V would derive its wordclock from the Digital Stereo Coaxial In connection,
and Pro Tools would derive its wordclock from the 01V’s Option I/O connection. The
sampling rate will be the same as that used when the DAT tape was recorded. If a CD
player is used instead of the DAT, the sampling rate will be fixed at 44.1 kHz, the indus-
try-standard for music CDs.
System Notes
• The AES/EBU connector on the MY8-AE card is connected to the XLR to 25-pin
D-sub splitter box using a 25-pin D-sub cable.
• The splitter box is connected to the 888 I/O Audio Interface using AES/EBU compat-
ible XLR cables.
• The 888 I/O Audio Interface is connected to the Pro Tools audio card using a special
50-pin Pro Tools cable.
• The XLR to 25-pin D-sub splitter box is custom made and not available from
Yamaha.
• A 25-pin D-sub to XLR break-out cable could be used instead of the splitter box.
01V—Owner’s Manual
01V & Pro Tools (AES/EBU) 251
Monitors
Power Amp
01V
MONITOR
(wordclock slave) OUT XLR cables
PHANTOM +48V OFF ON PHANTOM +48V OFF ON
INPUT (BAL)
–10dBV (UNBAL)
13 15 L
AES/EBU
14 16
IN OUT
2TR
PHONES
PAD
–16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 –16 –60 +10 –20 +10 –20 0 10 0 10
+10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 +10 GAIN –34 GAIN GAIN LEVEL LEVEL
MONITOR
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13/14 15/16 OUT PHONES
To computer
–12
PAN/ F F –15
DYNAMICS EQ/ATT Ø/DELAY ROUTING MEMORY –18
G LO-MID –24
–30
–36
FADER MODE –42
Serial port
EFFECT 1 EFFECT 2 OPTION I/O REMOTE G LOW –48
1 RETURN 2
SELECTED CHANNEL
AUX 1 AUX 2 AUX 3 AUX 4
DAT recorder
HOME
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON ON
SOLO
ON
SOLO
ON MEMORY
(wordclock slave)
MIDI IN OUT Digital in
DAT
–1/DEC +1/INC
PARAMETER
00.00.00.00
MIDI 6
5
6
5
6
5
6
5
6
5
6
5
6
5
6
5
6
5
6
5
6
5
6
5
6
5
6
5
0
–5
–10
–15
DIGITAL STEREO
interface
–20
COAXIAL
CURSOR
10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10
–30
20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 –40
–50
40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40
60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 –70
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
∞
– ∞
1
17
2
18
3
19
4
20
5
21
6
22
7
23
8
24
9 10 11 12 13/14 15/16 STEREO
MASTER
IN Digital out
Drum machine
Guitar processor
MIDI IN
Tone generator
MIDI IN
Bass processor
MIDI keyboard
MIDI IN
MIDI OUT
Vocals Drums
01V—Owner’s Manual
252 Chapter 18—System Examples
01V—Owner’s Manual
Troubleshooting 253
Troubleshooting
Symptom Advice
Make sure that the power cord is connected to a suitable AC wall out-
let. See “Connecting the Power Cord” on page 11 for more informa-
tion.
Cannot turn on the 01V.
Make sure that the 01V POWER switch is set to the ON position. See
“Turning On the 01V” on page 11 for more information.
If you still cannot turn on the 01V, contact your Yamaha dealer.
Try adjusting the contrast. See “Display, Selected Channel Controls &
The display is difficult to read.
Meters” on page 16 for more information.
Make sure that the +48 V phantom power is turned on for that input.
Connected a condenser-type If a phone plug is plugged into the same input channel, the XLR input
microphone but it doesn’t work. is disabled. See “Input Channel Overview” on page 40 for more infor-
mation.
Make sure that the GAIN control and PAD switch are set correctly. See
Input channel signal levels are too Gain and Pad on page 41.
low or too high. Use the HOME pages to check signal levels. See “Metering Signal Lev-
els” on page 83 for more information.
Make sure that you have selected the right fader mode. See “Faders
Faders don’t function as expected.
(plus Return Rotary Controls)” on page 35 for more information.
[SEL] buttons don’t function as Make sure that you have selected the correct fader mode. See “SEL
expected. Buttons” on page 32 for more information.
[SOLO] buttons don’t function as Make sure that you have selected the correct fader mode. See “Solo
expected. Buttons” on page 33 for more information.
[ON] buttons don’t function as Make sure that you have selected the correct fader mode. See “ON
expected. Buttons” on page 34 for more information.
Effects Return Rotary controls don’t Make sure that you have selected the correct fader mode. See “Faders
function as expected (plus Return Rotary Controls)” on page 35 for more information.
Cannot send signals from input This is correct. Input channels 17 through 24 can only be sent to aux
channels 17 through 24 to aux sends 1 and 2. See “About the Aux Sends” on page 94 for more infor-
sends 3 and 4. mation.
Input signals 1 through 8 appear on Probably because the inputs have been swapped. See “Swapping
input channels 17 through 24. Inputs 1–8 & 17–24” on page 51 for more information.
Raise the STEREO fader and turn on the STEREO [ON] button. Make
Input signals are present but the
sure that the input channels are routed to the stereo output. See
stereo output is dead.
“Routing Input Channels” on page 49 for more information.
01V—Owner’s Manual
254 Troubleshooting
Symptom Advice
Channels seem to run out of Use the Attenuator function on the EQ page to reduce the level. See
headroom, especially when EQ “Attenuating Input Channel Signals” on page 43 for more informa-
boost is applied. tion.
Probably because these inputs have been flipped with the Digital Ste-
Cannot hear signals connected to
reo Coaxial In on PAN/ROUT page 4. See “Digital Stereo In” on page
inputs 13 and 14.
213 for more information.
The 2TR IN signal appears on input Probably because the 15/16–2TR IN switch is set to 2TR IN. See
channels 15 and 16. “Two-track Input (2TR IN)” on page 77 for more information.
Cannot hear signals connected to Probably because the 15/16–2TR IN switch is set to 2TR IN. See
inputs 15 and 16. “Two-track Input (2TR IN)” on page 77 for more information.
Bus out master levels are set using the virtual faders on PAN/ROUT
Cannot select the bus out master
page 3. See “Setting Bus Out Master Levels” on page 109 for more
faders.
information.
Recordings made via the Digital Make sure that the Dither function is set to match the wordlength of
Stereo Coaxial Out or Option I/O the digital recorder. See “Output Dither” on page 212 for more infor-
sound grainy. mation.
Input channels are configured as a Make sure that the odd channel is panned hard left and the right
stereo pair but the signal appears to channel is panned hard right. See “Panning Input Channels” on page
be mono. 47 for more information.
Make sure that the phase of both input channels in the stereo pair is
Configured a stereo pair but the
set the same. Phase settings are not linked when channels are paired.
signal sounds out of phase.
See “Changing the Input Phase” on page 42 for more information.
Make sure that the Channel Delay function is set correctly. See “Delay-
Signals sound delayed.
ing Channel Signals” on page 45 for more information.
Added faders to a fader group but Make sure that the fader group is enabled. See “Grouping Faders” on
grouping does not work. page 55 for more information.
01V—Owner’s Manual
Troubleshooting 255
Symptom Advice
Added channels to a mute group Make sure that the mute group is enabled. See “Grouping Mutes” on
but group muting does not work. page 56 for more information.
Cannot locate the aux send Aux send panpots are only available when aux sends are paired. See
panpots. “Pairing Aux Sends” on page 101 for more information.
The bus master level faders work in Probably because the bus outs are paired. See “Pairing Bus Outs” on
unison. page 111 for more information.
These effects programs use the HQ. PITCH and FREEZE type effects
Cannot recall effects programs 19
and can only be recalled to Effect 2. See “Preset Effects Programs” on
and 42 to Effect 1.
page 121 for more information.
Cannot recall mix scenes. Only scene memories that contain data can be recalled.
Help! I recalled a mix scene by Use the Undo function to return to the previous mix settings. See
mistake. “Undoing Mix Scene Recalls” on page 189 for more information.
This is because a scene memory other than the one last recalled has
The scene memory number keeps
been selected but not recalled. See “Scene Memory Display Area” on
flashing.
page 185 for more information.
Recalling a mix scene doesn’t Perhaps these channels are safe channels? See “Recalling Scene Data
update some channels. Safely” on page 192 for more information.
The specified fade time has no Fade Time settings must be stored in mix scenes before they take
effect. effect. See “Setting a Fade Time” on page 191 for more information.
01V—Owner’s Manual
256 Troubleshooting
Symptom Advice
Try calibrating the faders. See “Calibrating the Faders” on page 204
Fader movements are inconsistent.
for more information.
This warning message appears if digital signals from the Digital Stereo
Coaxial In or Option I/O inputs are not wordclock synchronized with
DIGITAL IN Sync Error message
the 01V. Make sure that all digital equipment is wordclock synchro-
appears.
nized to a common wordclock source. See “Setting the Wordclock”
on page 209 for more information.
Make sure the external wordclock source is turned on and that the
UNLOCK appears in the Fs window
cable carrying the wordclock signal has not been disconnected. See
of SETUP page 1.
“Setting the Wordclock” on page 209 for more information.
Cannot receive MIDI Bulk Dump Make sure that the BULK Rx switch on MIDI page 1 is turned on. See
data. “MIDI Setup” on page 224 for more information.
Perhaps the Local Control function on MIDI page 5 is turned off? See
Controls have no effect on the 01V.
“Local Control” on page 234 for more information.
01V—Owner’s Manual
Analog Digital Digital Analog
STEREO MASTER MASTER MASTER
Analog Digital PAD GAIN ADC METER PHASE ATT EQ DYNAMICS DELAY ON/OFF LEVEL PAN BUS EQ LEVEL DYNAMICS BALANCE ON/OFF METER DAC
dB dB Bit
Max. [+24dB]
Input Clipping Level
+24 0 0
+20 1 Max.
Output [+18dB]
–10 2 [+10dB]
+10
3 Nominal Nominal
+4 –20 Input
0 Output [+4dB]
4 GAIN MINI,
Stereo Out
–30 5 PAD ON Monitor Out
–10 6 OMNI1–4 Out
–40
–20 7
8
–50
–30 9
–60 10
–40 11
–70 12
–50
–80 13
–60 14
Nominal Input [–60dB]
–90 15
–70 16 GAIN MAX,PAD OFF
01V Level Diagram
–100 17
–80
–110 18
–90 19
–120 20
–100 21
–130 22
–110
–140 23
–120 24
–150 25
–130 26
–160
–140 27
28
–170
–150 29
–180 30
–160 31
–190 DSP Noise Floor
–170 32
33
–200
–180 34
–210 35
–190
36
01V Level Diagram
257
01V—Owner’s Manual
Appendix A: General
258 Appendix A: General
Display Messages
Message Meaning
The byte count of the received Bulk Dump data is not cor-
BULK: Byte Count Mismatch!
rect.
The check sum of the received Bulk Dump data is not cor-
BULK: Check Sum Error!
rect.
The Bulk Dump data cannot be stored because the desti-
BULK: Memory Protected!
nation is write-protected.
This warning message appears if the Digital Stereo Coaxial
In signal is not wordclock synchronized with the 01V.
Make sure that all digital equipment is wordclock synchro-
nized to a common wordclock source. See “Setting the
DIGITAL IN Sync Error!
Wordclock” on page 209 for more information. This warn-
ing message can be disabled by turning off the DIGITAL IN
SYNC CAUTION option in the preferences (“Setting 01V
Preferences” on page 203).
The selected effect program can be recalled only to
For Effect2 Only.
Effect 2.
The internal battery voltage is getting very low. Back up
LOW BATTERY!! the Setup data (“Bulk Dump” on page 232), and ask your
dealer to replace the battery.
Memory Protected Cannot execute as selected scene memory is protected.
MIDI IN: Framing Error! An incorrect signal may have been input to the MIDI IN.
MIDI IN: Data Overrun! An incorrect signal may have been input to the MIDI IN.
MIDI: Rx Buffer Full! The 01V is probably receiving too much MIDI data.
MIDI: Tx Buffer Full! The 01V is probably transmitting too much MIDI data.
NO DATA Cannot execute as no data has been stored.
Local Control cannot be turned off while a mix-scene fade
Now Fading(Fade Time).
is in progress (Fade Time).
This warning message appears if the Option I/O input dig-
ital signal is not wordclock synchronized with the 01V.
Make sure that all digital equipment is wordclock synchro-
nized to a common wordclock source. See “Setting the
OPTION IN Sync Error!
Wordclock” on page 209 for more information. This warn-
ing message can be disabled by turning off the DIGITAL IN
SYNC CAUTION option in the preferences (“Setting 01V
Preferences” on page 203).
Read Only Cannot execute as selected scene memory is read only.
Selected channel: CHxx CHxx is the selected channel.
Preparing to LOCAL OFF... The MIDI Local Control function is preparing for use.
An incorrect signal may have been input to the TO HOST
TO HOST: Framing Error!
connector.
An incorrect signal may have been input to the TO HOST
TO HOST: Data Overrun!
connector.
An incorrect signal may have been input to the TO HOST
TO HOST: Data Parity Error!
connector.
The 01V is probably receiving too much MIDI data at the
TO HOST: Rx Buffer Full!
TO HOST connector.
The 01V is probably transmitting too much MIDI data
TO HOST: Tx Buffer Full!
from the TO HOST connector.
The received wordclock is not correct and the 01V cannot
WRONG WORD CLOCK! synchronize correctly. Select a suitable wordclock, or use
the AUTO NAVIGATE function on the SETUP page 1.
01V—Owner’s Manual
Security Cover 259
Security Cover
For certain applications you may wish to fit a protective cover over the 01V’s GAIN con-
trols and PAD switches. Although Yamaha do not make such a cover, the 01V has four
fixing holes to affix a custom-made cover. If you fit such a cover, make sure that the fix-
ing screws do not protrude inside the 01V by more than 10 mm. The fixing holes accept
M3-size machine screws, and are spaced 40.0 mm vertically, 414 mm horizontally.
Rack-mounting Kit
The 01V can be rack mounted using the optional RK124 Rack Mount Kit. See your
Yamaha dealer for details.
Attach the rack-mount brackets as shown below.
01V—Owner’s Manual
260 Appendix A: General
01V—Owner’s Manual
General 261
Appendix B: Specifications
General
Internal 44.1 kHz
Sampling rate
External 44.1 kHz (–10%) to 48 kHz (+6%)
Fader 15 × 60 mm motorized
01V—Owner’s Manual
262 Appendix B: Specifications
CH 1–12
CH 13/14
ON & SEL buttons CH 15/16
STEREO/MASTER (AUX 1–4, EFFECT 1, 2)
RETURN 1, 2
CH 1–12
CH 13/14
Faders
CH 15/16
STEREO/MASTER (AUX 1–4, EFFECT 1, 2)
Encoders RETURN 1, 2
CH 1–12
CH 13/14
SOLO buttons
CH 15/16
Digital controls RETURN 1, 2
SELECTED CHANNEL
EQ buttons HIGH, HI-MID, LO-MID, LOW
Encoders PAN, F (EQ), G (EQ)
320 × 80 dot
LCD
Graphic LCD w/backlight and contrast control
Display
ST OUT meters, 12 elements × 2
LED
SOLO mode indicator
Power consumption 70 W
01V—Owner’s Manual
Input Channels 1–16 263
Phase Normal/Reverse
ON/OFF
60 mm motorized
Fader
INPUT, AUX 1, AUX 2, AUX 3, AUX 4, EFFECT 1, EFFECT 2
ON/OFF
Solo
AFL/PFL
Displayed on LCD
Metering
Peak hold ON/OFF
01V—Owner’s Manual
264 Appendix B: Specifications
ON/OFF
Fader 60 mm motorized
ON/OFF
Solo
AFL/PFL
Displayed on LCD
Metering
Peak hold ON/OFF
Digital Stereo In
De-emphasis Automatic de-emphasis filter (15 µs/50 µs)
ON/OFF
Rotary encoder
Level control
INPUT, AUX 1, AUX 2, AUX 3, AUX 4, EFFECT 1, 2
ON/OFF
Solo
AFL/PFL
Displayed on LCD
Metering
Peak hold ON/OFF
01V—Owner’s Manual
Bus 1–4 265
Bus 1–4
Master level
ON/OFF
ON/OFF
Monitor
AFL/PFL
Displayed on LCD
Metering
Peak hold ON/OFF
Aux 1–4
EQ 4-band PEQ (Low, Lo-Mid, Hi-Mid, High)
Fader 60 mm motorized
ON/OFF
ON/OFF
Monitor
AFL/PFL
Displayed on LCD
Metering
Peak hold ON/OFF
Stereo Out
EQ 4-band PEQ (Low, Lo-Mid, Hi-Mid, High)
Fader 60 mm motorized
Balance
ON/OFF
ON/OFF
Monitor
AFL/PFL
01V—Owner’s Manual
266 Appendix B: Specifications
Mono
ON/OFF
Dither
Word length: 16–24 bit
Effects Library 99 42 57
Dynamics Library 80 40 40
EQ Library 80 40 40
01V—Owner’s Manual
EQ 267
EQ
Low Lo-Mid*1 Hi-Mid1 High
Gain (G) –18.0 dB to +18.0 dB (0.5 dB steps)*2
Frequency (F) 21 Hz–20.1 kHz (1/12 octave steps, 120 steps)
HPF, 10.0–0.10 LPF, 10.0–0.10
Q (41 steps), 10.0–0.10 (41 steps) (41 steps),
L.SHELF H.SHELF
*1. 4-band EQs only (low and high bands only on input channels 17 through 24).
*2. When the low and high EQ bands are configured as HPF and LPF, their gain controls function
as filter on and off switches.
01V—Owner’s Manual
268 Appendix B: Specifications
Analog Inputs
Actual For Use Input level
Connector in
Connection PAD GAIN Load With Max.
Sensitivity*1 Nominal Console
Impedance Nominal Before Clip
–66 dB –60 dB –46 dB
0 –60 XLR-3-31 type
50–600 Ω (388 µV) (775 µV) (3.88 mV)
(balanced)*2
Input chan- Mics –22 dB –16 dB –2 dB
0 3 kΩ &
nels 1–12 & (61.6 mV) (123 mV) (616 mV)
–16 TRS phone jack
600 Ω Lines +4 dB +10 dB +24 dB
26 (balanced)*3
(1.23 V) (2.45 V) (12.3 V)
–26 dB –20 dB –6 dB
–20
Input channels (38.8 mV) (77.5 mV) (388 mV) TRS phone jack
10 kΩ 600 Ω Lines
13–16 +4 dB +10 dB +24 dB (balanced)3
+10
(1.23 V) (2.45 V) (12.3 V)
–10 dBV –10 dBV +4 dBV Phono
2TR IN (L, R) 10 kΩ 600 Ω Lines
(316 mV) (316 mV) (1.58 V) (unbalanced)
*1. Sensitivity is the lowest level that will produce an output of +4 dB (1.23 V) or the nominal output level when
the 01V is set to maximum gain (all faders and level controls at maximum positions).
*2. Input channel XLR-type connectors are balanced (pin 1 = ground, pin 2 = hot, pin 3 = cold).
*3. Input channel phone jacks are balanced (tip = hot, ring = cold, sleeve = ground).
* Where dB represents a specific voltage, 0 dB is referenced to 0.775 V rms.
* For 2TR IN levels, 0 dBV is referenced to 1.00 V rms.
* Input channels 1–16 and ST IN use linear 20-bit 128-times oversampling A/D converters.
* +48 V DC phantom powering switched in 6-channel blocks (1-6, 7-12) available via the XLR-type connectors
of input channels 1–12
Analog Outputs
Actual For Use Output Level
Connection Source With Max. Before Connector in Console
Impedance Nominal Nominal
Clip
01V—Owner’s Manual
Digital Audio Inputs 269
01V—Owner’s Manual
270 Appendix B: Specifications
Control I/O
Connection Format Level Connector
TO HOST — RS-422 8-pin mini DIN
MIDI IN MIDI — 5-pin DIN
MIDI THRU MIDI — 5-pin DIN
MIDI OUT MIDI — 5-pin DIN
01V—Owner’s Manual
01V Dimensions 271
01V Dimensions
H:148
D:520
W:430
01V—Owner’s Manual
272 Appendix B: Specifications
01V—Owner’s Manual
Scene Memory to Program Change Table 273
Appendix C: MIDI
Scene Memory to Program Change Table
Program Initial User Program Initial User Program Initial User
Change # Scene # Scene # Change # Scene # Scene # Change# Scene # Scene #
1 01 44 44 87 87
2 02 45 45 88 88
3 03 46 46 89 89
4 04 47 47 90 90
5 05 48 48 91 91
6 06 49 49 92 92
7 07 50 50 93 93
8 08 51 51 94 94
9 09 52 52 95 95
10 10 53 53 96 96
11 11 54 54 97 97
12 12 55 55 98 98
13 13 56 56 99 99
14 14 57 57 100 00
15 15 58 58 101 —
16 16 59 59 102 —
17 17 60 60 103 —
18 18 61 61 104 —
19 19 62 62 105 —
20 20 63 63 106 —
21 21 64 64 107 —
22 22 65 65 108 —
23 23 66 66 109 —
24 24 67 67 110 —
25 25 68 68 111 —
26 26 69 69 112 —
27 27 70 70 113 —
28 28 71 71 114 —
29 29 72 72 115 —
30 30 73 73 116 —
31 31 74 74 117 —
32 32 75 75 118 —
33 33 76 76 119 —
34 34 77 77 120 —
35 35 78 78 121 —
36 36 79 79 122 —
37 37 80 80 123 —
38 38 81 81 124 —
39 39 82 82 125 —
40 40 83 83 126 —
41 41 84 84 127 —
42 42 85 85 128 —
43 43 86 86
01V—Owner’s Manual
274 Appendix C: MIDI
0 NO ASSIGN
1 FADER CHANNEL CH1
2 FADER CHANNEL CH2
3 FADER CHANNEL CH3
4 FADER CHANNEL CH4
5 FADER CHANNEL CH5
6 FADER CHANNEL CH6
7 FADER CHANNEL CH7
8 FADER CHANNEL CH8
9 FADER CHANNEL CH9
10 FADER CHANNEL CH10
11 FADER CHANNEL CH11
12 FADER CHANNEL CH12
13 FADER CHANNEL CH13-14
14 FADER CHANNEL CH15-16
15 FADER CHANNEL RETURN1
16 FADER CHANNEL RETURN2
17 FADER MASTER AUX1
18 FADER MASTER AUX2
19 FADER MASTER AUX3
20 FADER MASTER AUX4
21 FADER MASTER BUS1
22 FADER MASTER BUS2
23 FADER MASTER BUS3
24 FADER MASTER BUS4
25 FADER MASTER EFFECT1
26 FADER MASTER EFFECT2
27 FADER MASTER ST OUT
28 ON CHANNEL CH1
29 ON CHANNEL CH2
30 ON CHANNEL CH3
31 ON CHANNEL CH4
32 NO ASSIGN
33 ON CHANNEL CH5
34 ON CHANNEL CH6
35 ON CHANNEL CH7
36 ON CHANNEL CH8
37 ON CHANNEL CH9
01V—Owner’s Manual
01V Parameter to Control Change Table 275
Control Parameter
Change # 01V Initial (Default) User
38 ON CHANNEL CH10
39 ON CHANNEL CH11
40 ON CHANNEL CH12
41 ON CHANNEL CH13-14
42 ON CHANNEL CH15-16
43 ON CHANNEL RETURN1
44 ON CHANNEL RETURN2
45 ON MASTER AUX1
46 ON MASTER AUX2
47 ON MASTER AUX3
48 ON MASTER AUX4
49 ON MASTER BUS1
50 ON MASTER BUS2
51 ON MASTER BUS3
52 ON MASTER BUS4
53 ON MASTER EFFECT1
54 ON MASTER EFFECT2
55 ON MASTER ST OUT
56 PAN CHANNEL CH1
57 PAN CHANNEL CH2
58 PAN CHANNEL CH3
59 PAN CHANNEL CH4
60 PAN CHANNEL CH5
61 PAN CHANNEL CH6
62 PAN CHANNEL CH7
63 PAN CHANNEL CH8
64 PAN CHANNEL CH9
65 PAN CHANNEL CH10
66 PAN CHANNEL CH11
67 PAN CHANNEL CH12
68 PAN CHANNEL CH13
69 PAN CHANNEL CH14
70 PAN CHANNEL CH15
71 PAN CHANNEL CH16
72 PAN CHANNEL RETURN1 L
73 PAN CHANNEL RETURN1 R
74 PAN CHANNEL RETURN2 L
75 PAN CHANNEL RETURN2 R
76 PAN BALANCE ST OUT
77 FADER EFF1 SEND CH1
78 FADER EFF1 SEND CH2
79 FADER EFF1 SEND CH3
01V—Owner’s Manual
276 Appendix C: MIDI
Control Parameter
Change # 01V Initial (Default) User
01V—Owner’s Manual
03D & Programmable Mixer 01 Parameter to Control Change Table 277
01V—Owner’s Manual
278 Appendix C: MIDI
Control Parameter
Change # 03D Arrangement Programmable Mixer 01 Arrangement
01V—Owner’s Manual
03D & Programmable Mixer 01 Parameter to Control Change Table 279
Control Parameter
Change # 03D Arrangement Programmable Mixer 01 Arrangement
01V—Owner’s Manual
280 MIDI Data Format
01V—Owner’s Manual
MIDI Data Format 281
01V—Owner’s Manual
282 MIDI Data Format
PARAMETER CHANGE (7bit operation for type PARAMETER CHANGE (byte operation for type
0x10:edit buffer) 0x01:system memory)
Reception Reception
This message is received if [Parameter Change RX] is ON and the [Rx When [Parameter Change RX] is ON, this message is received if the
CH] matches the Device Channel included in the SUB STATUS. [Rx CH] matches the Device Channel included in the SUB STATUS.
This is echoed if [Parameter Change ECHO] is ON. When [Parameter Change ECHO] is ON, this is echoed.
When this is received, the specified parameter will be controlled. When this is received, the specified parameter will be controlled.
Transmission STATUS 11110000 F0 System Exclusive Message
If [Parameter Change TX] is ON, this message is transmitted on the ID No. 01000011 43 Manufacturer's ID No.(YAMAHA)
SUB STATUS 0001nnnn 1n parameter change or response
[Tx CH] Device Channel when a parameter not specified in the n=0-15(Device Channel No.1-16)
[Control Assign Table] is modified. GROUOP ID 00111110 3e MODEL ID
MODEL ID 00000100 04 Device code (01V)
STATUS 11110000 F0 System Exclusive Message
PARAM TYPE 00000001 01 byte operation for system memory (type)
ID No. 01000011 43 Manufacturer's ID No.(YAMAHA)
DATA 0aaaaaaa dd0 address( H) high 7 bits of 14 bits address
SUB STATUS 0001nnnn 1n parameter change n=0-15(Device Chan-
0aaaaaaa dd1 address( L) low 7 bits of 14 bits address
nel No.1-16)
0000dddd dd2 data( H) high 4 bits of 8 bits data
GROUOP ID 00111110 3e MODEL ID
0000dddd dd3 data( L) low 4 bits of 8 bits data
MODEL ID 00000100 04 Device code (01V)
: : continuous address datas
PARAM TYPE 00010000 10 7bit operation for edit buffer (type)
EOX 11110111 F7 End Of Exclusive
DATA 0aaaaaaa dd0 address( H) high 7 bits of 14 bits address
0aaaaaaa dd1 address( L) low 7 bits of 14 bits address
0ddddddd dd2 data 7bit The system memory will depend on the address, as follows.
: :
EOX 11110111 F7 End Of Exclusive 0x0000 - 0x007F : setup memory(128byte)
0x0080 - 0x0147 : backup memory(200byte)
0x0200 : card type(1byte)
The valid range of addresses is 0x0000 - 0x03FF
PARAMETER CHANGE (bit operation for type PARAMETER CHANGE (bit operation for type
0x40:edit buffer) 0x41:system memory)
Reception Reception
When [Parameter Change RX] is ON, this message is received if the When [Parameter Change RX] is ON, this message is received if the
[Rx CH] matches the Device Channel included in the SUB STATUS. [Rx CH] matches the Device Channel included in the SUB STATUS.
If [Parameter Change ECHO] is ON, this message will be echoed. When [Parameter Change ECHO] is ON, this is echoed.
When this message is received, the specified parameter will be con- When this is received, the specified parameter will be controlled.
trolled. STATUS 11110000 F0 System Exclusive Message
ID No. 01000011 43 Manufacturer's ID No.(YAMAHA)
Transmission SUB STATUS 0001nnnn 1n parameter change or response
If [Parameter Change TX] is ON, this message is transmitted on the n=0-15(Device Channel No.1-16)
[Tx CH] Device Channel when a parameter not specified in the GROUOP ID 00111110 3e MODEL ID
MODEL ID 00000100 04 Device code (01V)
[Control Assign Table] is modified.
PARAM TYPE 01000001 41 bit operation for system memory (type)
STATUS 11110000 F0 System Exclusive Message DATA 0aaaaaaa dd0 address( H) high 7 bits of 14 bits address
ID No. 01000011 43 Manufacturer's ID No.(YAMAHA) 0aaaaaaa dd1 address( L) low 7 bits of 14 bits address
SUB STATUS 0001nnnn 1n parameter change n=0-15(Device Chan- 0ddddddd dd2 data(bit0-2:change bit no.0-7, bit3:0=reset
nel No.1-16) 1=set)
GROUOP ID 00111110 3e MODEL ID : :
MODEL ID 00000100 04 Device code (01V) EOX 11110111 F7 End Of Exclusive
PARAM TYPE 01000000 40 bit operation for edit buffer (type)
DATA 0aaaaaaa dd0 address( H) high 7 bits of 14 bits address
0aaaaaaa dd1 address( L) low 7 bits of 14 bits address The system memory will depend on the address, as follows.
0ddddddd dd2 data(bit0-2:change bit no.0-7, bit3:0=reset 0x0000 - 0x007F : setup memory(128byte)
1=set) 0x0080 - 0x0147 : backup memory(200byte)
: :
EOX 11110111 F7 End Of Exclusive
01V—Owner’s Manual
MIDI Data Format 283
01V—Owner’s Manual
284 MIDI Data Format
PARAMETER CHANGE (type operation for type PARAMETER CHANGE (type 0x04:multiple linking)
0x03:controller(LCD-Fader mode))
Reception This message is valid only for the connector that has been specified as
When [Parameter Change RX] is ON and the [Rx CH] matches the the LINK PORT.
Device Channel included in the SUB STATUS, the message will be When two '01V' units have been connected by a cable, some of the
received. functions (refer to the following table) will be linked.
When [Parameter Change ECHO] is ON, this message will be ech- The same LINK PORT connector settings must be made on both
oed. units.
When this message is received, the LCD screen, the corresponding Reception
Fader Mode, and the specified channel will be selected. This message is always received, and will execute the LINK function
STATUS 11110000 F0 System Exclusive Message (refer to the following table). (This is not dependent on
ID No. 01000011 43 Manufacturer's ID No.(YAMAHA) MIDI-SETUP.)
SUB STATUS 0001nnnn 1n parameter change n=0-15(Device Chan-
nel No.1-16) Transmission
GROUOP ID 00111110 3e MODEL ID This message is transmitted when LINK-related functions (refer to
MODEL ID 00000100 04 Device code (01V) following table) are performed. (This is not dependent on
PARAM TYPE 01000011 03 controller (type)
MIDI-SETUP.)
DATA 00000001 01 control No.(LCD-Fader mode)
0ddddddd dd channel select(0-30) When [Parameter Change ECHO] is ON, this message is transmitted
0ddddddd dd LCD select No.(0-17) without change.
0000dddd dd PAGE No.(0-4)
EOX 11110111 F7 End Of Exclusive STATUS 11110000 F0 System Exclusive Message
ID No. 01000011 43 Manufacturer's ID No.(YAMAHA)
SUB STATUS 0001nnnn 1n n=0-15(Tx/Rx Channel No.1-16)
PARAMETER CHANGE (bit operation for type GROUOP ID 00111110 3e MODEL ID
MODEL ID 00000100 04 Device code (01V)
0x43:controller(key remote)) PARAM TYPE 00000100 04 multiple linking
DATA 0mmfffff mf data format (bit6-5:status, bit4-0:contents)
Reception
0ddddddd dd0 data #0
When [Parameter Change RX] is ON and the [Rx CH] matches the 0ddddddd dd1 data #1
Device Channel included in the SUB STATUS, this message will be : :
received. EOX 11110111 F7 End Of Exclusive
When [Parameter Change ECHO] is ON, this message will be ech-
oed. Status Function Note
----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
When this message is received, the same processing will be performed
0x00 scene recall Recall the specified memory number
as when the specified key (refer to the table below) is pressed 0x01 scene store Store to the specified memory number with title
(released). (Assign the same title to all)
0x02 scene title edit If the title was modified, make it the same, make it
Transmission match
When [Parameter Change ECHO] is ON, this message will be trans- 0x48 solo mode Match the solo mode
mitted without change. bit6: enable/disable
bit5: on/off
STATUS 11110000 F0 System Exclusive Message bit2: recording/mixdown
ID No. 01000011 43 Manufacturer's ID No.(YAMAHA) bit1: sel mix/last
SUB STATUS 0001nnnn 1n parameter change n=0-15(Device Chan- bit0: after fader/pre fader
nel No.1-16) 0x60 display call When the screen (Fader Mode) is changed, make it
GROUOP ID 00111110 3e MODEL ID match
MODEL ID 00000100 04 Device code (01V) 0x61 metering point Make the meter points match
PARAM TYPE 01000011 43 controller 0x62 peak hold Make the meter Peak Hold ON/OFF match
DATA 00000000 00 control no.(0:key remote)
0ddddddd dd No. 0-10,99-102(key 1-11,100-103)
0000dddd dd data(bit0-2:change bit no.0-7,
bit3:0=reset 1=set)
: :
EOX 11110111 F7 End Of Exclusive
KEY key no.bit0 bit1 bit2 bit3 bit4 bit5 bit6 bit7
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
key1 0 ON1 ON2 ON3 ON4 ON5 ON6 ON7 ON8
key2 1 ON9 ON10 ON11 ON12 ON13-14 ON15-16 ONSTOUT ------
key3 2 SOLO1 SOLO2 SOLO3 SOLO4 SOLO5 SOLO6 SOLO7 SOLO8
key4 3 SOLO9 SOLO10 SOLO11 SOLO12 SOLO13-14SOLO15-16 ------ ------
key5 4 SEL1 SEL2 SEL3 SEL4 SEL5 SEL6 SEL7 SEL8
key6 5 SEL9 SEL10 SEL11 SEL12 SEL13-14 SEL15-16 SEL STO ------
key7 6 ONRTN1 ONRTN2 SOLORT1 SOLORT2 SELRTN1 SELRTN2 HOME MEMORY
key8 7 AUX1 AUX2 AUX3 AUX4 EFFECT1 EFFECT2 OPTION REMOTE
key9 8 LOW L-MID H-MID HIGH ------ ------ ------ ------
key10 9 UP LEFT RIGHT DOWN ENTER INC DEC ------
key11 10 DYNAMIX EQ DELAY PAN UTILITY MIDI SETUP VIEW
key100 99 FRZ-REC FRZ-PLAY ------ ------ ------ ------ ------ ------
key101 100 SOLO1 SOLO2 SOLO3 SOLO4 SOLO5 SOLO6 SOLO7 SOLO8
key102 101 SOLO9 SOLO10 SOLO11 SOLO12 SOLO13-14SOLO15-16 SOLO-RTN1 SOLO-RTN2
key103 102 SOLO17 SOLO18 SOLO19 SOLO20 SOLO21 SOLO22 SOLO23 SOLO24
* The keys followed by 100 are virtual key, it would be the keys on
LCD.
01V—Owner’s Manual
MIDI Data Format 285
EOX
:
11110111
:
F7 End Of Exclusive
REQUEST
In the Meter no., bit 6 is the special bit, and bit 5 is the gr bit. These messages input and output the contents of various types of
When the Gr bit is on, the single byte gr will be added uniformly to internal memory.
the end of the data string. The unique header identifies whether or not the data is for the 01V.
When the Special bit is on, the two bytes stLED L/R will be added uni- The CHECK SUM is calculated by adding the data following the
formly to the end of the data string. BYTE COUNT(LOW) until the data preceding the CHECK SUM,
When both are on, gr comes first, and stLED L/R come later. then inverting the bits (2's complement), and setting bit 7 to 0.
CHECK SUM = ( -sum) & 0x7F
PARAMETER VALUE REQUEST(type 0x05:remote Reception
meter) This is received if [Bulk RX] is ON and the [Rx CH] matches the
Device Channel that is included in SUB STATUS.
This message is used to obtain meter data from the 01V. It is used in When a BULK DUMP is received, it will immediately be written into
LOCAL OFF MODE to display the meter of the remote device, or to the specified memory.
display the meter on the screen of a personal computer, etc. When a BULK DUMP REQUEST is received, a bulk dump will be
In order to obtain meter data, the meter whose data is required must transmitted immediately.
be displayed in the LCD of the remote device. This means that before Transmission
transmitting this request, you must first transmit the In the [MIDI-BULK] page, this is transmitted on the [Tx CH] chan-
above-described "4.6.4.11 PARAMETER CHANGE (type 0x03:bit nel by key operations.
operation for controller(LCD-Fader mode))" to display the appro- In response to a Bulk Dump Request, a Bulk Dump Message is trans-
priate meter in the LCD screen of the remote device. mitted on the [Rx CH] channel.
Reception data name rx/tx function
When [Parameter Change RX] is ON and the [Rx CH] matches the ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Device Channel included in SUB STATUS, this message will be 'M' rx/tx Scene Memory & Request
'S' rx/tx Setup Memory & Request
received.
'I' rx/tx Remote(Internal Parameter) Memory & Request
When this message is received, Parameter Change (remote meter) 'L' rx/tx Remote(MMC) Memory & Request
messages will begin to be transmitted on the [Rx CH] channel. 'U' rx/tx Remote(User Define) Memory & Request
'C' rx/tx Control Change Assign Table & Request
Transmission 'P' rx/tx Program Change Assign Table & Request
When [LOCAL OFF] is ON, transmit a meter data request for the 'Q' rx/tx Equalizer Library & Request
currently displayed meter on the [Tx CH]. For each request, meter 'Y' rx/tx Dynamics Library & Request
'E' rx/tx Effect Library & Request
data will be transmitted for five seconds. If you want meter data con-
tinuously for longer than this, you will need to transmit requests at
intervals of five seconds or less. When the 01V is in LOCAL OFF
MODE, transmit requests at approximately one-second intervals.
When [Parameter Change ECHO] is ON and the 01V itself did not
receive this message, the message will be echoed.
01V—Owner’s Manual
286 MIDI Data Format
SCENE MEMORY BULK DUMP FORMAT SETUP MEMORY BULK DUMP REQUEST FORMAT
STATUS 11110000 F0 System Exclusive Message STATUS 11110000 F0 System Exclusive Message
ID No. 01000011 43 Manufacturer's ID No.(YAMAHA) ID No. 01000011 43 Manufacturer's ID (YAMAHA)
SUB STATUS 0000nnnn 0n n=0-15(Device Channel No.1-16) SUB STATUS 0010nnnn 2n n=0-15(Device Channel No.1-16)
FORMAT No. 01111110 7E Universal Bulk Dump FORMAT No. 01111110 7E Universal Bulk Dump
BYTE COUNT(HIGH) 00010000 10 2048(2038+10)bytes 01001100 4C 'L'
BYTE COUNT(LOW) 00001010 00 01001101 4D 'M'
01001100 4C 'L' 00100000 20 ''
01001101 4D 'M' 00100000 20 ''
00100000 20 '' 00111000 38 '8'
00100000 20 '' 01000010 42 'B'
00111000 38 '8' 00110011 33 '3'
01000010 42 'B' 00110100 34 '4'
00110011 33 '3' DATA NAME 01010011 53 'S'
00110100 34 '4' 00100000 20 ''
DATA NAME 01001101 4D 'M' EOX 11110111 F7 End Of Exclusive
0mmmmmmm mm m=0-99,127(Scene Memory No.0-99,
edit buffer)
Receive is effective No.1-99,127 REMOTE(Internal Parameter) MEMORY BULK
DATA 0ddddddd ds Scene Memory(10+(1014*2) bytes) DUMP FORMAT
: :
0ddddddd de STATUS 11110000 F0 System Exclusive Message
CHECK SUM 0eeeeeee ee ee=(INVERT('L'+'M'+...+ds+...+de)+1) ID No. 01000011 43 Manufacturer's ID No.(YAMAHA)
AND 7Fh SUB STATUS 0000nnnn 0n n=0-15(Device Channel No.1-16)
EOX 11110111 F7 End Of Exclusive FORMAT No. 01111110 7E Universal Bulk Dump
BYTE COUNT(HIGH) 00000000 00 100(90+10)bytes
BYTE COUNT(LOW) 01100100 64
The ten bytes at the beginning are the ID + title, and are 7 bit data. 01001100 4C 'L'
The subsequent 1014 bytes are all split into 4 bit data. 01001101 4D 'M'
00100000 20 ''
00100000 20 ''
SCENE MEMORY BULK DUMP REQUEST FORMAT 00111000 38 '8'
STATUS 11110000 F0 System Exclusive Message 01000010 42 'B'
ID No. 01000011 43 Manufacturer's ID (YAMAHA) 00110011 33 '3'
SUB STATUS 0010nnnn 2n n=0-15(Device Channel No.1-16) 00110100 34 '4'
FORMAT No. 01111110 7E Universal Bulk Dump DATA NAME 01001001 49 'I'
01001100 4C 'L' 0bbbbbbb bb b = 0-3(bank no.1-4)
01001101 4D 'M' DATA 0ddddddd ds Remote(Internal Parameter) Mem-
00100000 20 '' ory(90bytes)
00100000 20 '' : :
00111000 38 '8' 0ddddddd de
01000010 42 'B' CHECK SUM 0eeeeeee ee ee=(INVERT('L'+'M'+...+ds+...+de)+1)
00110011 33 '3' AND 7Fh
00110100 34 '4' EOX 11110111 F7 End Of Exclusive
DATA NAME 01001101 4D 'M'
0mmmmmmm mm m=0-99,127(Scene Memory No.0-99,cur-
rent)
All data is 7 bit data.
EOX 11110111 F7 End Of Exclusive
REMOTE(Internal Parameter) MEMORY BULK
SETUP MEMORY BULK DUMP FORMAT DUMP REQUEST FORMAT
STATUS 11110000 F0 System Exclusive Message
STATUS 11110000 F0 System Exclusive Message
ID No. 01000011 43 Manufacturer's ID (YAMAHA)
ID No. 01000011 43 Manufacturer's ID No.(YAMAHA)
SUB STATUS 0010nnnn 2n n=0-15(Device Channel No.1-16)
SUB STATUS 0000nnnn 0n n=0-15(Device Channel No.1-16)
FORMAT No. 01111110 7E Universal Bulk Dump
FORMAT No. 01111110 7E Universal Bulk Dump
01001100 4C 'L'
BYTE COUNT(HIGH) 00000010 02 266(256+10)bytes
01001101 4D 'M'
BYTE COUNT(LOW) 00001010 0A
00100000 20 ''
01001100 4C 'L'
00100000 20 ''
01001101 4D 'M'
00111000 38 '8'
00100000 20 ''
01000010 42 'B'
00100000 20 ''
00110011 33 '3'
00111000 38 '8'
00110100 34 '4'
01000010 42 'B'
DATA NAME 01001001 49 'I'
00110011 33 '3'
0bbbbbbb bb b = 0-3(bank no.1-4)
00110100 34 '4'
EOX 11110111 F7 End Of Exclusive
DATA NAME 01010011 53 'S'
00100000 20 ''
DATA 0ddddddd ds Setup Memory(128*2bytes)
: :
0ddddddd de
CHECK SUM 0eeeeeee ee ee=(INVERT('L'+'M'+...+ds+...+de)+1)
AND 7Fh
EOX 11110111 F7 End Of Exclusive
01V—Owner’s Manual
MIDI Data Format 287
REMOTE(MMC) MEMORY BULK DUMP FORMAT REMOTE(User Define) MEMORY BULK DUMP
STATUS 11110000 F0 System Exclusive Message
REQUEST FORMAT
ID No. 01000011 43 Manufacturer's ID No.(YAMAHA) STATUS 11110000 F0 System Exclusive Message
SUB STATUS 0000nnnn 0n n=0-15(Device Channel No.1-16) ID No. 01000011 43 Manufacturer's ID (YAMAHA)
FORMAT No. 01111110 7E Universal Bulk Dump SUB STATUS 0010nnnn 2n n=0-15(Device Channel No.1-16)
BYTE COUNT(HIGH) 00000000 00 34(24+10)bytes FORMAT No. 01111110 7E Universal Bulk Dump
BYTE COUNT(LOW) 00100010 22 01001100 4C 'L'
01001100 4C 'L' 01001101 4D 'M'
01001101 4D 'M' 00100000 20 ''
00100000 20 '' 00100000 20 ''
00100000 20 '' 00111000 38 '8'
00111000 38 '8' 01000010 42 'B'
01000010 42 'B' 00110011 33 '3'
00110011 33 '3' 00110100 34 '4'
00110100 34 '4' DATA NAME 01010101 55 'U'
DATA NAME 01001100 4C 'L' 0bbbbbbb bb bb = 0-3(bank no. 1-4)
00100000 20 '' EOX 11110111 F7 End Of Exclusive
DATA 0ddddddd ds Remote(MMC) Memory(24bytes)
: :
0ddddddd de EQUALIZER LIBRARY BULK DUMP FORMAT
CHECK SUM 0eeeeeee ee ee=(INVERT('L'+'M'+...+ds+...+de)+1)
AND 7Fh STATUS 11110000 F0 System Exclusive Message
EOX 11110111 F7 End Of Exclusive ID No. 01000011 43 Manufacturer's ID No.(YAMAHA)
SUB STATUS 0000nnnn 0n n=0-15(Device Channel No.1-16)
FORMAT No. 01111110 7E Universal Bulk Dump
All data is 7 bit data. BYTE COUNT(HIGH) 00000000 00 46(36+10)bytes
BYTE COUNT(LOW) 00101110 2E
REMOTE(MMC) MEMORY BULK DUMP REQUEST 01001100 4C 'L'
01001101 4D 'M'
FORMAT 00100000 20 ''
00100000 20 ''
STATUS 11110000 F0 System Exclusive Message
00111000 38 '8'
ID No. 01000011 43 Manufacturer's ID (YAMAHA)
01000010 42 'B'
SUB STATUS 0010nnnn 2n n=0-15(Device Channel No.1-16)
00110011 33 '3'
FORMAT No. 01111110 7E Universal Bulk Dump
00110100 34 '4'
01001100 4C 'L'
DATA NAME 01010001 51 'Q'
01001101 4D 'M'
0mmmmmmm mm m= 0-79 (Equalizer Library No.1-80)
00100000 20 ''
96-124(ch1-12,13/14,15/16,RTN1/2,AUX
00100000 20 ''
1-4,ST MAS,ch17-24)
00111000 38 '8'
Receive is effective No.40-79,96-125
01000010 42 'B'
DATA 0ddddddd ds Equalizer Library Mem-
00110011 33 '3'
ory(12+(12*2)bytes)
00110100 34 '4'
: :
DATA NAME 01001100 4C 'L'
0ddddddd de
00100000 20 ''
CHECK SUM 0eeeeeee ee ee=(INVERT('L'+'M'+...+ds+...+de)+1)
EOX 11110111 F7 End Of Exclusive
AND 7Fh
EOX 11110111 F7 End Of Exclusive
REMOTE(User Define) MEMORY BULK DUMP
FORMAT The twelve bytes at the beginning are the title, and are 7 bit data. The
STATUS 11110000 F0 System Exclusive Message following twelve bytes are all split into 4 bit data.
ID No. 01000011 43 Manufacturer's ID No.(YAMAHA)
SUB STATUS 0000nnnn 0n n=0-15(Device Channel No.1-16) EQUALIZER LIBRARY BULK DUMP REQUEST
FORMAT No. 01111110 7E Universal Bulk Dump
BYTE COUNT(HIGH) 00001011 0B 1450(1440+10)bytes
FORMAT
BYTE COUNT(LOW) 00101010 2A STATUS 11110000 F0 System Exclusive Message
01001100 4C 'L' ID No. 01000011 43 Manufacturer's ID (YAMAHA)
01001101 4D 'M' SUB STATUS 0010nnnn 2n n=0-15(Device Channel No.1-16)
00100000 20 '' FORMAT No. 01111110 7E Universal Bulk Dump
00100000 20 '' 01001100 4C 'L'
00111000 38 '8' 01001101 4D 'M'
01000010 42 'B' 00100000 20 ''
00110011 33 '3' 00100000 20 ''
00110100 34 '4' 00111000 38 '8'
DATA NAME 01010101 55 'U' 01000010 42 'B'
0bbbbbbb bb bb = 0-3(bank no. 1-4) 00110011 33 '3'
DATA 0ddddddd ds Remote(User Define) Memory(1440bytes) 00110100 34 '4'
: : DATA NAME 01010001 51 'Q'
0ddddddd de 0mmmmmmm mm m= 0-79 (Equalizer Library No.1-80)
CHECK SUM 0eeeeeee ee ee=(INVERT('L'+'M'+...+ds+...+de)+1) 96-124(ch1-12,13/14,15/16,RTN1/2,AUX
AND 7Fh 1-4,ST MAS,ch17-24)
EOX 11110111 F7 End Of Exclusive EOX 11110111 F7 End Of Exclusive
01V—Owner’s Manual
288 MIDI Data Format
DYNAMICS LIBRARY BULK DUMP FORMAT EFFECT LIBRARY BULK DUMP FORMAT
STATUS 11110000 F0 System Exclusive Message STATUS 11110000 F0 System Exclusive Message
ID No. 01000011 43 Manufacturer's ID No.(YAMAHA) ID No. 01000011 43 Manufacturer's ID No.(YAMAHA)
SUB STATUS 0000nnnn 0n n=0-15(Device Channel No.1-16) SUB STATUS 0000nnnn 0n n=0-15(Device Channel No.1-16)
FORMAT No. 01111110 7E Universal Bulk Dump FORMAT No. 01111110 7E Universal Bulk Dump
BYTE COUNT(HIGH) 00000000 00 36(26+10)bytes BYTE COUNT(HIGH) 00000000 00 104(94+10)bytes
BYTE COUNT(LOW) 00100100 24 BYTE COUNT(LOW) 01101000 68
01001100 4C 'L' 01001100 4C 'L'
01001101 4D 'M' 01001101 4D 'M'
00100000 20 '' 00100000 20 ''
00100000 20 '' 00100000 20 ''
00111000 38 '8' 00111000 38 '8'
01000010 42 'B' 01000010 42 'B'
00110011 33 '3' 00110011 33 '3'
00110100 34 '4' 00110100 34 '4'
DATA NAME 01011001 59 'Y' DATA NAME 01000101 45 'E'
0mmmmmmm mm m= 0-79 (Dynamics Library No.1-80) 0mmmmmmm mm m= 0-98 (Effect Library No.1-99)
96-114(ch1-12,13/14,15/16,AUX1-4,ST 112-113(Effct1, Effect2)
MAS) Receive is effective 42-98,112-113
Receive is effective No.40-79,96-115 DATA 0ddddddd ds Effect Library Memory(12+(41*2)bytes)
DATA 0ddddddd ds Dynamics Library Mem- : :
ory(12+(7*2)bytes) 0ddddddd de
: : CHECK SUM 0eeeeeee ee ee=(INVERT('L'+'M'+...+ds+...+de)+1)
0ddddddd de AND 7Fh
CHECK SUM 0eeeeeee ee ee=(INVERT('L'+'M'+...+ds+...+de)+1) EOX 11110111 F7 End Of Exclusive
AND 7Fh
EOX 11110111 F7 End Of Exclusive
The first twelve bytes are the title, and are 7 bit data. The following 41
bytes are all split into 4 bit data.
The first twelve bytes are the title, and are 7 bit data. The following
seven bytes are all split into 4 bit data. EFFECT LIBRARY BULK DUMP REQUEST FORMAT
DYNAMICS LIBRARY BULK DUMP REQUEST STATUS 11110000 F0 System Exclusive Message
ID No. 01000011 43 Manufacturer's ID (YAMAHA)
FORMAT SUB STATUS 0010nnnn 2n n=0-15(Device Channel No.1-16)
FORMAT No. 01111110 7E Universal Bulk Dump
STATUS 11110000 F0 System Exclusive Message
01001100 4C 'L'
ID No. 01000011 43 Manufacturer's ID (YAMAHA)
01001101 4D 'M'
SUB STATUS 0010nnnn 2n n=0-15(Device Channel No.1-16)
00100000 20 ''
FORMAT No. 01111110 7E Universal Bulk Dump
00100000 20 ''
01001100 4C 'L'
00111000 38 '8'
01001101 4D 'M'
01000010 42 'B'
00100000 20 ''
00110011 33 '3'
00100000 20 ''
00110100 34 '4'
00111000 38 '8'
DATA NAME 01000101 45 'E'
01000010 42 'B'
0mmmmmmm mm m= 0-98 (Effect Library No.1-99)
00110011 33 '3'
112-113(Effect1, Effect2)
00110100 34 '4'
EOX 11110111 F7 End Of Exclusive
DATA NAME 01011001 59 'Y'
0mmmmmmm mm m= 0-79 (Dynamics Library No.1-80)
96-114(ch1-12,13/14,15/16,AUX1-4,ST
MAS)
EOX 11110111 F7 End Of Exclusive
01V—Owner’s Manual
MIDI Data Format 289
PROGRAM CHANGE ASSIGNMENT TABLE BULK Control Change Assignment Table Bulk Dump
DUMP FORMAT Format
STATUS 11110000 F0 System Exclusive Message STATUS 11110000 F0 System Exclusive Message
ID No. 01000011 43 Manufacturer's ID No.(YAMAHA) ID No. 01000011 43 Manufacturer's ID No.(YAMAHA)
SUB STATUS 0000nnnn 0n n=0-15(Device Channel No.1-16) SUB STATUS 0000nnnn 0n n=0-15(Device Channel No.1-16)
FORMAT No. 01111110 7E Universal Bulk Dump FORMAT No. 01111110 7E Universal Bulk Dump
BYTE COUNT(HIGH) 00000001 01 138(128+10)bytes BYTE COUNT(HIGH) 00000010 02 352(342+10)bytes
BYTE COUNT(LOW) 00001010 0A BYTE COUNT(LOW) 01100000 60
01001100 4C 'L' 01001100 4C 'L'
01001101 4D 'M' 01001101 4D 'M'
00100000 20 '' 00100000 20 ''
00100000 20 '' 00100000 20 ''
00111000 38 '8' 00111000 38 '8'
01000010 42 'B' 01000010 42 'B'
00110011 33 '3' 00110011 33 '3'
00110100 34 '4' 00110100 34 '4'
DATA NAME 01010000 50 'P' DATA NAME 01000011 43 'C'
00100000 20 '' 00100000 20 ''
DATA 0ddddddd ds Program Change Table(128bytes) DATA 0ddddddd ds Control Change Table(114x3bytes)
: : : :
0ddddddd de 0ddddddd de
CHECK SUM 0eeeeeee ee ee=(INVERT('L'+'M'+...+ds+...+de)+1) CHECK SUM 0eeeeeee ee ee=(INVERT('L'+'M'+...+ds+...+de)+1)
AND 7Fh AND 7Fh
EOX 11110111 F7 End Of Exclusive EOX 11110111 F7 End Of Exclusive
PROGRAM CHANGE ASSIGNMENT TABLE BULK CONTROL CHANGE ASSIGNMENT TABLE BULK
DUMP REQUEST FORMAT DUMP REQUEST FORMAT
STATUS 11110000 F0 System Exclusive Message STATUS 11110000 F0 System Exclusive Message
ID No. 01000011 43 Manufacturer's ID (YAMAHA) ID No. 01000011 43 Manufacturer's ID (YAMAHA)
SUB STATUS 0010nnnn 2n n=0-15(Device Channel No.1-16) SUB STATUS 0010nnnn 2n n=0-15(Device Channel No.1-16)
FORMAT No. 01111110 7E Universal Bulk Dump FORMAT No. 01111110 7E Universal Bulk Dump
01001100 4C 'L' 01001100 4C 'L'
01001101 4D 'M' 01001101 4D 'M'
00100000 20 '' 00100000 20 ''
00100000 20 '' 00100000 20 ''
00111000 38 '8' 00111000 38 '8'
01000010 42 'B' 01000010 42 'B'
00110011 33 '3' 00110011 33 '3'
00110100 34 '4' 00110100 34 '4'
DATA NAME 01010000 50 'P' DATA NAME 01000011 43 'C'
00100000 20 '' 00100000 20 ''
EOX 11110111 F7 End Of Exclusive EOX 11110111 F7 End Of Exclusive
01V—Owner’s Manual
YAMAHA [Digital Mixing Console—Internal Parameters] Date: 01 Feb. 1998
Model: 01V MIDI Implementation Chart Version: 1.0
Note X 0–127
Number True Voice ************** X
Note On X O
Velocity
Note Off X O
After Keys X X
Touch Ch’s X X
Pitch bend X X
Control
0–95, 102–119 O O Assignable
Change
System Exclusive O O *1
:Song Pos X X
System
:Song Sel X X
Common
:Tune X X
System :Clock X X
Real Time :Commands X X
:Local ON/OFF X X
Aux :All Notes OFF X X
Messages :Active Sense X O
:Reset X O
Appendix D: Resources
Books
• Introducing Digital Audio, Ian R Sinclair, second edition, PC Publishing, 1992. A
good all-around introduction to digital audio. Second edition explains oversampling
and bitstream techniques.
• Principles of Digital Audio, Ken C. Pohlmann, Howard W.Sams & Co, 1989. Covering
all aspects of digital audio, this book is ideal for newcomers who want to know the
basics plus a bit more.
• The Art of digital Audio, John Watkinson, Focal Press (Butterworth Group), 1990. An
essential read for digital audio professionals—but only for the serious!
• The MIDI Ins, Outs & Thrus, Jeff Rona, Hal Leonard Publishing, 1992. An excellent
introduction to MIDI with many illustrations for easy understanding.
• MIDI Systems & Control, Francis Rumsey, second edition, Focal Press, 1994. Covers
all MIDI topics in detail and looks at how MIDI can be used to control systems (i.e.,
digital mixers, synths).
• THE MIDI BOOK, Steve DeFuria with Joe Scacciaferro, Hal Leonard Books. A good
introduction for anyone new to MIDI.
• THE MIDI RESOURCE BOOK, Steve DeFuria with Joe Scacciaferro, Hal Leonard
Books, 1988. Following on from THE MIDI BOOK, this one looks at the real nuts
and bolts of MIDI including the MIDI specification and how to read MIDI Imple-
mentation Charts.
• Yamaha Sound Reinforcement Handbook, Gary Davis and Ralph Jones, second edi-
tion, Hal Leonard Publishing Corporation, 1990. Although primarily concerned
with sound reinforcement, many of the subjects covered also apply to studio audio
applications. The second edition also includes a comprehensive section on MIDI.
01V—Owner’s Manual
292 Appendix D: Resources
01V—Owner’s Manual
Glossary 293
Glossary
A/D converter—An electronic device for converting analog signals to digital signals.
AFL (After Fader Listen)—Monitoring signals after the channel fader. Contrast with
PFL.
Aliasing—A type of signal distortion that occurs during A/D conversion if the sam-
pling rate is less than twice that of the highest audio frequency. A/D converters employ
aliasing filters to remove audio frequencies higher than half the sampling rate. See also
Nyquist Sampling Theorem.
Anti-aliasing—In digital audio, a technique used to prevent aliasing in the form of an
anti-aliasing filter before A/D conversion. This filter removes audio frequencies that are
higher than half the sampling frequency (e.g., for a 32 kHz sampling rate, audio fre-
quencies above 16 kHz are filtered).
Balancing—A technique for reducing interference in audio cables by using two con-
ductors, known as the hot (+) and cold (–), to carry two versions of the audio signal,
180 degrees out of phase with each other. Since any interference picked up will be in the
same phase on both conductors, the differential amplifier at the balanced input cancels
out the noise, but amplifies the audio signal.
Bulk Dump—A MIDI function for transferring data between MIDI equipment. Data
is transmitted as MIDI System Exclusive messages.
Bus—A common conductor used to collect and distribute audio signals.
Cascade—A technique for increasing the number of available inputs by connecting
two or more audio mixers together.
CH—Abbreviation for channel.
Clipping—The unwanted distortion effect caused by inputting too large a signal to an
audio circuit.
Coaxial—The electrical connection for transmitting and receiving consumer format
digital audio, typically using phono connectors. See also Consumer format.
Consumer format—The consumer digital audio format, developed by Sony and
Philips, for transferring digital audio data between consumer-type digital audio equip-
ment, such as CD players, DAT, DCC, and MiniDisc decks. Two channels of digital
audio (left & right) are carried in one connection, usually a phono connection. This
format is also referred to as IEC60958 (formerly 958) and S/PDIF. See also Coaxial.
Control Change—A type of MIDI message providing real-time parameter control.
Typical Control Changes include Modulation, Volume, Pan, and Portamento.
D/A converter—An electronic device for converting digital signals to analog signals.
De-emphasis—See Emphasis.
DIO—Abbreviation for digital input and output.
Dither—The process of adding low-level random noise to audio signals in order to
reduce A/D converter quantization noise. Dither techniques are also used for digital
audio wordlength reduction (e.g., 20 to 16-bit conversion).
DSP (Digital Signal Processor)—A chip designed specifically for processing large
amounts of data at high speed and in real time. This type of processor is ideal for han-
dling digital audio data.
Dynamic range—The difference between the loudest and quietest signal levels in a
system. In an audio device, usually the difference between the maximum output level
and the residual noise floor. In a digital system, the available dynamic range is deter-
01V—Owner’s Manual
294 Glossary
mined by the data resolution, about 6 dB per digital bit. Hence, a 16-bit system theo-
retically provides a 96 dB dynamic range.
Edit buffer—The memory area used to store the current mix settings. When a mix
scene is stored, the Edit Buffer data is stored to the selected scene memory. When a mix
scene is recalled, the data of the selected scene memory is copied into the Edit Buffer.
EFF—Abbreviation for effect.
Emphasis—A technique used to improve the noise performance of first generation
AD/DA converters by boosting analog signals above 3.5 kHz by 6 dB/octave prior to
A/D conversion. Emphasis was subsequently detected by the D/A converter and
de-emphasis applied after D/A conversion. Although not used anymore, emphasis
functions are often provided for compatibility with old digital recordings.
EQ snapshot—A set of EQ settings.
Fade time—The time it takes faders to move to new positions when a mix scene is
recalled. Can be used for crossfading between channels.
Fs—Abbreviation for sampling frequency.
General MIDI (GM)—An extension to the MIDI Standard that, among other things,
states that a General MIDI tone generator must be at least 24-note polyphonic, have 16
parts, and 128 specific preset voices.
GR—Abbreviation for gain reduction.
Initial settings—The settings used when a device is first turned on after leaving the
factory. Also known as the default, or factory settings.
LCD (Liquid Crystal Display)—A type of display device that uses liquid crystals to
generate characters and graphics.
LED (Light Emitting Diode)—A type of diode that lights up when an electric cur-
rent is applied.
Line-Level Signal—A high-level signal in the range from –20 dB to +20 dB. Most
audio equipment outputs signals at line level. Contrast with Low-Level Signal.
Low-Level Signal—A signal in the range from –100 dB to –20 dB. Microphone and
electric guitar signals are in this range. Contrast with Line-Level Signal.
LSB (Least Significant Byte)—The byte of a digital word that represents the lowest
value. Contrast with MSB.
MIDI (Musical Instrument Digital Interface)—An internationally agreed stan-
dard that allows electronic musical instruments and audio equipment to communicate.
MIDI Device Number—A numbering scheme used to identify individual devices in
a MIDI system, commonly used for transmitting System Exclusive data.
Mix scene—A set of mixer settings. Just like a play, a piece of music consists of various
scenes, each requiring different mixer settings. Mix scenes are stored in scene memo-
ries, and can be recalled manually or using MIDI Program Changes, which can be sent
from a computer, MIDI footswitch, keyboard, or sequencer. See also Scene memories.
MMC (MIDI Machine Control)— A set of MIDI messages for controlling record-
ers, video tape machines, and other studio equipment. Typical MMC commands
include Stop, Play, Rewind, and Pause.
Mdulation—A technique for controlling a signal’s frequency (pitch) or amplitude
(level) using an LFO (low frequency oscillator). The LFO frequency is set using modu-
lation speed parameters and the amount of LFO control is set using modulation depth
parameters.
01V—Owner’s Manual
Glossary 295
MSB (Most Significant Byte)—The byte of a digital word that represents the high-
est value. Contrast with LSB
Noise gate—An electronic switch that opens if the trigger signal falls below a speci-
fied threshold and closes if the trigger signal exceeds the threshold. Typically used to
shut off unwanted hiss and noise.
Nominal level—See Operating Level.
Nyquist theorem—The Nyquist theorem states that the sampling rate of a digital
audio system must be at least twice that of the highest audio frequency, otherwise wave-
form distortion know as aliasing will occur. See also Aliasing.
OMNI—The MIDI mode in which a device responds to MIDI data on all 16 channels.
Operating level—This is the signal level at which a piece of audio equipment is
designed to operate. The two most common operating levels are –10 dBV (316 mV),
which is used by semiprofessional equipment, and +4 dBu (1.23 V), which is used by
professional equipment.
Oversampling—Sampling an audio signal at a rate higher than the actual sampling
rate to reduce noise caused by quantization errors.
PAM (Pulse Amplitude Modulation)—In the first part of the A/D conversion
process, pulses occurring at the sampling rate are modulated by an analog audio signal.
See also PCM.
PC—Originally, the abbreviation for personal computer. Although today it’s used as
the generic name for any IBM-compatible personal computer, usually running a ver-
sion of the Microsoft Windows operating system.
PCM (Pulse Code Modulation)—In the second part of the A/D conversion pro-
cess, the pulses derived using PAM are converted into binary data words using PCM.
See also PAM.
Peaking—A type of EQ circuit used to cut and boost a band of frequencies, producing
a mountain-peak type response. The width of the band is called the Q. Midband EQ is
usually of the peaking type. Compare with Shelving.
PEQ—An abbreviation for parametric EQ.
PFL (Pre Fader Listen)—Monitoring signals before the channel fader. Contrast with
AFL.
Phantom powering—The technique for supplying condenser-type microphones a
DC voltage via the signal carrying conductors of a balanced cable.
Pink noise—A type of random noise that contains an equal amount of energy per
octave. For example, the bands 100–200, 800–1600, and 3000–6000 all contain the same
amount of energy. White noise, on the other hand, has an equal amount of energy per
frequency band. That is, 100–200, 800–900, and 3000–3100.
Post fader—The point in the signal path after the fader. Aux sends are often config-
ured as post-fader sends, which means the aux send signal is sourced after the channel
fader. The advantage of this is that the aux send signal can be controlled at the same
time as the main channel signal using the same fader. Post-fader aux sends are typically
used to feed effects processors. See also AFL.
Pre fader—The point in the signal path before the fader. Aux sends are often config-
ured as pre-fader sends, which means the aux send signal is sourced before the channel
fader. The advantage of this is that the aux send signal can be controlled independently
of the main channel signal. Pre-fader aux sends are often used for foldback mixes. See
also PFL.
Program Change—A type of MIDI message for selecting programs.
01V—Owner’s Manual
296 Glossary
Q—The unit used to express a filter’s selectivity. High values imply a narrow frequency
band, low values, a wide frequency band.
Quantization—The PCM process in which PAM pulses are approximated to the
nearest binary value available.
S/PDIF format—See Coaxial format.
Sampling rate — The number of times per second analog audio signals are sampled
(i.e., measured) during A/D conversion. Common digital audio sampling rates are
32 kHz, 44.1 kHz, and 48 kHz.
Scene memories—Memory locations used to store mix scenes. See also Mix scene.
Shelving—A type of EQ circuit used to cut and boost frequencies above or below a set
frequency. It produces a shelf-looking response curve. High and low EQs are usually of
the shelving type. Contrast with Peaking.
Signal-to-noise ratio (S/N)—In an audio system, the difference between the oper-
ating signal level and the residual noise floor expressed as a decibel ratio, commonly
used to measure a system’s noise performance.
Snapshot—See Mix scene.
ST OUT—The 01V stereo output.
System Exclusive—A type of MIDI message for exclusive use with a particular
device. See also Bulk Dump.
THD (Total Harmonic Distortion)—The measure of distortion introduced by an
audio system relative to the audio signal expressed as a percentage. Compared to
third-harmonic distortion, which is the measure of a single harmonic, total harmonic
distortion is the sum of distortions produced at all harmonics.
Unity gain—A gain of one.
Wordclock—A clock signal used to synchronize the data processing circuits of all
devices connected in a digital audio system. The wordclock frequency is the same as the
sampling rate.
01V—Owner’s Manual
Index 297
01V—Owner’s Manual
298 Index
01V—Owner’s Manual
Index 299
01V—Owner’s Manual
300 Index
H pairing 52
panning 47
M
Headphones. See PHONES phase 42 Mains lead 11
Height, 01V dimensions 271 routing 49 Memory area, display 29
HIGH button 63 specifications 263 MEMORY page 1 186, 187, 189,
HI-MID button 63 swapping inputs 51 190
HOME page 1 83 swapping settings 59 MEMORY page 2 191
HOME page 2 83 viewing settings 57 MEMORY page 3 190
HOME page 3 84 Input jacks 20 MEMORY page 4 192
HOME page 4 84 Input meter page 83 Messages, display 258
HOME page 5 85 Input swap page 51 Metering
Home page, Yamaha web site 291 Inputs and outputs 20 aux sends 83
HPF 62 Internal parameter page 194 bus outs 83
HQ.PITCH 144 Interval time, MIDI bulk dump 232 effects returns 83
Inv gang, pan mode 48 effects sends 86
input channels 83
I main stereo output meters 84
Implementation chart, MIDI 290 L metering point 85
omni outs 84
INC button 31 Latch, user define 238 option I/O 85
INC/DEC SCENE RECALL, LCD, definition 294 peak hold 84
preference 203 LED, definition 294 stereo output 84
Individual, pan mode 48 Level diagram 257 Metering point page 85
Initial settings, definition 294 Level setting Mic inputs 20
Initializing aux sends 99 MIDI
01V 204 bus outs 109 about 222
internal parameter banks 194 effects returns 131 about the connectors
parameter to control change effects send masters 128 about 23
table 229 input channels 46 bulk dump 232
scene memory to program stereo output 90 bulk page 232
change table 227 Libraries bulk setup 226
user defined MIDI controllers dynamics 173 control change page 229
238 effects 132 control change setup 225
INPUT (BAL) 1–12 20 EQ 67 data format 280
INPUT (BAL) 13–16 20 LIBRARY LIST ORDER, preference definition 294
Input channels 204 implementation chart 290
1 through 12 40 Line inputs 20 linking 01Vs 239
13 through 16 40 Line-level signal, definition 294 local control 234
17 through 24 40 Link port local control page 234
attenuator 43 about 222 MMC 236
aux sends 50 selecting 224 parameter change setup 225
block diagram 60 using 224 parameter control 229
copying settings 59 Linking 01Vs 239 ports 222
delay 45 LISTEN program change page 227
dynamics processors 164 monitoring 78 program change setup 225
EQ 63 solo 80 receive channel 225
grouping faders 55 Local control 234 receive indicators 224
grouping mutes 56 Locate points scene recall 227
level setting 46 MMC 236 setup 224
metering 83 LO-MID button 63 setup page 224
monitoring 50 LOW button 63 summary 7
muting 46 Low-level signal, definition 294 system exclusive parameter
omni outs 50 LPF 62 control 231
option I/O 50 LSB, definition 294 transmit channel 225
overview 40
01V—Owner’s Manual
Index 301
user define page 238 aux sends 100 about the cards 216
user defined controllers 238 bus outs 109 assigning outputs 219
using ports 223 effects returns 130 aux sends 94
MIDI data format 280 effects send masters 129 block diagram 220
MIDI Device Number, definition grouping channels 56 bus outs 108
294 input channels 46 card specs 217
MIDI page 1 224 stereo output 90 control page 43, 63, 95, 97, 123,
MIDI page 2 227 MY4-AD 4 Analog Input 216 126
MIDI page 3 229 MY4-DA Analog Output 216 input channels 50
MIDI page 4 232 MY8-AD 8 Analog Input 216 input specifications 264
MIDI page 5 234 MY8-AE AES/EBU 216 installing cards 218
Mix parameter, input delay 45 MY8-AT ADAT 216 metering 85
Mix scenes MY8-TD Tascam 216 output specifications 266
definition 294 select page 219
Mix scenes. See Scene memories stereo output 88
Mixdown solo mode 80 N summary 6
MMC 236 swapping inputs 51
Naming. See Titling
definition 294 OPTION I/O slot
Noise gate, definition 295
MMC control page 236 about 23
Nominal fader indicator 30
MOD.DELAY 140 available cards 216
Nominal Level, definition 295
MOD.FILTER 146 installing cards 218
Normal phase 42
Modulation, definition 294 Option in meter page 85
Nyquist theorem, definition 295
MONI TRIM 78 Option out meter page 85
MONITOR OUT OPTION page 1 85
about 22 OPTION page 2 43, 47, 49, 58, 63,
using 77
O 95, 97, 123, 126
MONITOR OUT LEVEL control Omni OPTION page 3 85
about 15 definition 295 OPTION page 4 219
using 77 OMNI OUT 22 OPTION page 5 51
Monitor setup page 78 Omni out select page 116 Oscillator 202
MONITOR–2TR IN switch Omni outs Oscillator page 202
about 15 about 116 Output delay page 91, 117
using 77 assigning 116 Oversampling, definition 295
Monitoring aux sends 94
about 76 block diagram 118
AFL/PFL 78 bus outs 108
connectors 22
P
aux sends 94 PAD switch
block diagram 79 D/A converters 116
about 15
bus outs 108 delay 117
using 41
D/A converters 77 input channels 50
Page area, display 29
effects returns 131 meter page 84
Pages
input channels 50 metering 84
aux pan 102
MONITOR OUT 22 specifications 265
aux pre/post 95, 96, 97, 99, 100
MONITOR–2TR IN switch 77 stereo output 88
bulk 232
mono/stereo 78 ON buttons
bus master 109, 110
setup 78 about 18
CH copy 59
specifications 266 aux sends 100
CH13-14 flip 213
stereo output 88 effects send masters 129
control change 229
using 78 fader modes 34
control, option I/O 43, 47, 49,
MONO DELAY 139 input channels 46
58, 63, 95, 97, 123, 126
Motorized faders 5 master 90
Delay 45
MSB, definition 295 reassigning 194
dither 212
MULTI FILTER 156 Operating level, definition 295
dynamics edit 164, 165, 166
Muting Option I/O
01V—Owner’s Manual
302 Index
dynamics library 174, 175, 176 channel aux sends 102 POWER switch 23
effect pre/post 125 effects returns 47, 131 Powering down the 01V 11
effects edit 123, 124, 136, 137, input channels 47 Powering up the 01V 11
157 modes 48 Pre fader, definition 295
effects library 132, 133, 134, 135 PAN/ROUT page 47 Pre/post
EQ 43, 63, 64, 65 PANPOT AUTO SCREEN, aux sends 97
EQ library 67, 68, 69, 70 preference 203 effects sends 125
fade time 191 Panpot page 47 monitoring 78
group 55, 56 Parameter boxes, display 30 solo 80
input meter 83 Parameter change Preferences 203
input swap 51 echo 225 Preferences pages 203
internal parameter 194 on/off 225 Preset programs
local control 234 Parameter control dynamics list 163
memory 186, 187, 189, 190 system exclusive 231 dynamics parameters 177
memory sort 190 PARAMETER wheel 31 effects list 121
metering point 85 Parameters effects parameters 138
MIDI setup 224 Dynamics processors preset EQ list 67
MMC control 236 programs 177 EQ parameters 71
monitor setup 78 effects preset programs 138 Pro Tools, system 250
omni out meter 84 EQ preset programs 71 Problem solving 253
omni out select 116 PCM, definition 295 Program change
option I/O out select 219 Peak hold 84 definition 295
option in meter 85 Peaking echo 225
option out meter 85 definition 295 MIDI bulk dump 232
oscillator 202 EQ 62 omni 225
output delay 91, 117 PEQ, definition 295 on/off 225
pair 52, 101, 111 PFL, definition 295 page 227
panpot 47 PFL/AFL. See AFL/PFL scene memory assignment table
phase 42 PHANTOM +48V ON–OFF 273
preferences 203 switches 22 scene memory assignments 227
program change 227 Phantom powering 41 scene recall 227
recall safe 192 Phantom powering, definition 295 using 228
routing 49 Phase 42 Programmable mixer 01 parameter
RTN/output meter 83 Phase page 42 to control change
solo setup 80 PHASER 143 assignment table 277
ST out meter 84 Phone inputs 20 Programs
user define 238 PHONES jack dynamics list 163
view 57, 86, 89, 98, 127, 130 connector 21 dynamics parameters 177
wordclock select 209 using 77 effects list 121
Pair page 52, 101, 111 PHONES LEVEL control effects parameters 138
Pairing about 15 EQ list 67
aux sends 101 using 77 EQ parameters 71
aux sends block diagram 105 Pink noise Protecting scene memories 189
bus outs 111 definition 295
input channels 52 pink noise 202
input channels pair block Ports Q
diagram 54 about 222 Q
PAM, definition 295 MIDI 23 adjusting 63
PAN/ROUT page 1 47 selecting 224 definition 296
PAN/ROUT page 2 49 TO HOST 23 Quantization, definition 296
PAN/ROUT page 3 109, 110 using MIDI 223
PAN/ROUT page 4 116, 213 using TO HOST 223
Panning Post fader, definition 295
bus to stereo 110 Power cord 11
01V—Owner’s Manual
Index 303
R S Solo
about 76
Rack mounting 259 Safe channels, mix scenes 192 AFL/PFL 80
Rear panel 22 Sampling rate block diagram 82
Reassigning faders & on buttons definition 296 modes 80
194 setting 209 setup 80
RECALL CONFIRMATION, Scene memories stereo output 88
preference 203 about 184 using 81
Recalling definition 296 SOLO buttons
dynamics programs 175 display area 185 about 18
effects programs 134 edit buffer 185 fader modes 33
EQ programs 69 edit indicator 185 Solo setup page 80
scene memories 187 fade time 191 SOLO status indicator 19
undoing mix scene recalls 189 fade time page 191 SOLO TRIM 80
Receive channel, MIDI 225 memory 00 185 Sonic performance 5
Recording solo mode 80 memory page 186, 187, 189, Specifications 280
Releasing 190 analog inputs 268
aux send pairs 101 memory sort page 190 analog outputs 268
bus out pairs 111 MIDI bulk dump 232 aux sends 265
input channel pairs 53 number of memories 266 bus outs 265
REMOTE page 1 194 program change assignment control I/O 270
REMOTE page 2 236 table 273 digital inputs 269
REMOTE page 3 238 protecting 189 digital outputs 269
Renumbering scene memories 190 recall safe page 192 digital stereo input 264
Request recalling 187 digital stereo output 266
local control 234 recalling via MIDI 188 effects returns 264
MIDI bulk dump 232 renumbering 190 EQ 267
Resetting the EQ 66 safe channels 192 general 261
Return controls storing 186 input channels 263
about 19 summary 7 monitor out 266
fader modes 35 titling 190 omni outs 265
REV+CHORUS 148 undoing recalls 189 option I/O inputs 264
REV+FLANGE 149 what’s stored 184 option I/O outputs 266
REV+SYMPHO 150 Security cover 259 stereo output 265
REV->CHORUS 149 SEL buttons ST out meter page 84
REV->FLANGE 150 about 18 STEREO DELAY 140
REV->PAN 151 fader modes 32 Stereo meters
REV->SYMPHO 151 SELECT CH MESSAGE, preference about 16
REVERB HALL 138 203 using 84
REVERB PLATE 138 Selected channel area, display 29 STEREO OUT 23
REVERB ROOM 138 Selected channel controls Stereo output
REVERB STAGE 138 about 16 2TR OUT 88
REVERSE GATE 139 EQ controls 63 about 88
Reverse phase 42 SETUP page 1 209 balancing 90
RING MOD 146 SETUP page 2 78, 80 block diagram 92
RK124, rack-mount kit 259 SETUP page 3 55, 56 connectors 23
ROTARY 145 SETUP page 4 52, 101, 111 D/A converters 88
Rotary controls, display 30 SETUP page 5 212 delay 91
Routing Shelving digital stereo output 88
bus to stereo 110 definition 296 dynamics processors 165
effects returns 49 EQ 62 EQ 65
input channels 49 Signal to noise ratio, definition 296 fader 90
page 49 Sine wave, oscillator 202 level setting 90
RTN/output meter page 83 Snapshot, definition 296 metering 84
01V—Owner’s Manual
304 Index
monitoring 88 Transmit
muting 90 local control 234
omni outs 88 MIDI bulk dump 232
option I/O 88 Transmit channel, MIDI 225
solo 88 Transport control, MMC 236
specifications 265 TREMOLO 144
viewing settings 89 Troubleshooting 253
STORE CONFIRMATION, Turning off the 01V 11
preference 203 Turning on the 01V 11
Storing
dynamics programs 174
effects programs 133 U
EQ programs 68 Undoing mix scene recalls 189
MIDI bulk dump 232 Unity gain, definition 296
scene memories 186 Unlatch, user define 238
SW, user define 238 User define page 238
Swapping channel settings 59 User defined MIDI controllers 238
Swapping input channels 51 UTILITY page 1 202
Switches, display 30 UTILITY page 2 203
Switching off the 01V 11
Switching on the 01V 11
SYMPHONIC 143
System examples
V
ADAT-interface recorder 242 VIEW page 1 57, 86, 89, 98, 127,
general 10 130
Pro Tools 250 VIEW page 2 57, 86, 89, 98, 127,
Tascam-interface recorder 246 130
Two ADAT-interface recorders VIEW page 3 59
244 Viewing settings
Two Tascam-interface aux sends 98
recorders 248 effects returns 130
System exclusive effects sends 127
definition 296 input channels 57
parameter control 231 stereo output 89
T W
Tamper proof cover 259 Web site 291
Tempo, effects parameter 137 Width, 01V dimensions 271
THD, definition 296 Wordclock
Title edit dialog box 37 about 206
Titling definition 296
dialog box 37 important information 11
dynamics programs 176 setting 209
effects programs 135 Wordclock select page 209
EQ programs 70 Wordlength 212
scene memories 190
TO HOST
about 222 X
about the connector XLR inputs 20
about 23
using 223
Top panel 14
01V—Owner’s Manual
interstage
Phistersvej 31, 2900 Hellerup, Danmark
Telefon 3946 0000, fax 3946 0040
www.interstage.dk
YAMAHA CORPORATION
Pro Audio Division, #18/3
P.O. Box 3, Hamamatsu, 430-8651, Japan
98 04 2000 AP Printed in Japan